| /* vi:set ts=8 sts=4 sw=4: |
| * |
| * VIM - Vi IMproved by Bram Moolenaar |
| * |
| * Do ":help uganda" in Vim to read copying and usage conditions. |
| * Do ":help credits" in Vim to see a list of people who contributed. |
| * See README.txt for an overview of the Vim source code. |
| */ |
| |
| /* |
| * misc1.c: functions that didn't seem to fit elsewhere |
| */ |
| |
| #include "vim.h" |
| #include "version.h" |
| |
| static char_u *vim_version_dir __ARGS((char_u *vimdir)); |
| static char_u *remove_tail __ARGS((char_u *p, char_u *pend, char_u *name)); |
| static int copy_indent __ARGS((int size, char_u *src)); |
| |
| /* All user names (for ~user completion as done by shell). */ |
| #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO) |
| static garray_T ga_users; |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in the current line. |
| */ |
| int |
| get_indent() |
| { |
| return get_indent_str(ml_get_curline(), (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "lnum". |
| */ |
| int |
| get_indent_lnum(lnum) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| return get_indent_str(ml_get(lnum), (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_FOLDING) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "lnum" of buffer |
| * "buf". |
| */ |
| int |
| get_indent_buf(buf, lnum) |
| buf_T *buf; |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| return get_indent_str(ml_get_buf(buf, lnum, FALSE), (int)buf->b_p_ts); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * count the size (in window cells) of the indent in line "ptr", with |
| * 'tabstop' at "ts" |
| */ |
| int |
| get_indent_str(ptr, ts) |
| char_u *ptr; |
| int ts; |
| { |
| int count = 0; |
| |
| for ( ; *ptr; ++ptr) |
| { |
| if (*ptr == TAB) /* count a tab for what it is worth */ |
| count += ts - (count % ts); |
| else if (*ptr == ' ') |
| ++count; /* count a space for one */ |
| else |
| break; |
| } |
| return count; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Set the indent of the current line. |
| * Leaves the cursor on the first non-blank in the line. |
| * Caller must take care of undo. |
| * "flags": |
| * SIN_CHANGED: call changed_bytes() if the line was changed. |
| * SIN_INSERT: insert the indent in front of the line. |
| * SIN_UNDO: save line for undo before changing it. |
| * Returns TRUE if the line was changed. |
| */ |
| int |
| set_indent(size, flags) |
| int size; /* measured in spaces */ |
| int flags; |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| char_u *newline; |
| char_u *oldline; |
| char_u *s; |
| int todo; |
| int ind_len; /* measured in characters */ |
| int line_len; |
| int doit = FALSE; |
| int ind_done = 0; /* measured in spaces */ |
| int tab_pad; |
| int retval = FALSE; |
| int orig_char_len = -1; /* number of initial whitespace chars when |
| 'et' and 'pi' are both set */ |
| |
| /* |
| * First check if there is anything to do and compute the number of |
| * characters needed for the indent. |
| */ |
| todo = size; |
| ind_len = 0; |
| p = oldline = ml_get_curline(); |
| |
| /* Calculate the buffer size for the new indent, and check to see if it |
| * isn't already set */ |
| |
| /* if 'expandtab' isn't set: use TABs; if both 'expandtab' and |
| * 'preserveindent' are set count the number of characters at the |
| * beginning of the line to be copied */ |
| if (!curbuf->b_p_et || (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi)) |
| { |
| /* If 'preserveindent' is set then reuse as much as possible of |
| * the existing indent structure for the new indent */ |
| if (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi) |
| { |
| ind_done = 0; |
| |
| /* count as many characters as we can use */ |
| while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*p)) |
| { |
| if (*p == TAB) |
| { |
| tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts |
| - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| /* stop if this tab will overshoot the target */ |
| if (todo < tab_pad) |
| break; |
| todo -= tab_pad; |
| ++ind_len; |
| ind_done += tab_pad; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| --todo; |
| ++ind_len; |
| ++ind_done; |
| } |
| ++p; |
| } |
| |
| /* Set initial number of whitespace chars to copy if we are |
| * preserving indent but expandtab is set */ |
| if (curbuf->b_p_et) |
| orig_char_len = ind_len; |
| |
| /* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */ |
| tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| if (todo >= tab_pad && orig_char_len == -1) |
| { |
| doit = TRUE; |
| todo -= tab_pad; |
| ++ind_len; |
| /* ind_done += tab_pad; */ |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* count tabs required for indent */ |
| while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts) |
| { |
| if (*p != TAB) |
| doit = TRUE; |
| else |
| ++p; |
| todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; |
| ++ind_len; |
| /* ind_done += (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; */ |
| } |
| } |
| /* count spaces required for indent */ |
| while (todo > 0) |
| { |
| if (*p != ' ') |
| doit = TRUE; |
| else |
| ++p; |
| --todo; |
| ++ind_len; |
| /* ++ind_done; */ |
| } |
| |
| /* Return if the indent is OK already. */ |
| if (!doit && !vim_iswhite(*p) && !(flags & SIN_INSERT)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| /* Allocate memory for the new line. */ |
| if (flags & SIN_INSERT) |
| p = oldline; |
| else |
| p = skipwhite(p); |
| line_len = (int)STRLEN(p) + 1; |
| |
| /* If 'preserveindent' and 'expandtab' are both set keep the original |
| * characters and allocate accordingly. We will fill the rest with spaces |
| * after the if (!curbuf->b_p_et) below. */ |
| if (orig_char_len != -1) |
| { |
| newline = alloc(orig_char_len + size - ind_done + line_len); |
| if (newline == NULL) |
| return FALSE; |
| todo = size - ind_done; |
| ind_len = orig_char_len + todo; /* Set total length of indent in |
| * characters, which may have been |
| * undercounted until now */ |
| p = oldline; |
| s = newline; |
| while (orig_char_len > 0) |
| { |
| *s++ = *p++; |
| orig_char_len--; |
| } |
| |
| /* Skip over any additional white space (useful when newindent is less |
| * than old) */ |
| while (vim_iswhite(*p)) |
| ++p; |
| |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| todo = size; |
| newline = alloc(ind_len + line_len); |
| if (newline == NULL) |
| return FALSE; |
| s = newline; |
| } |
| |
| /* Put the characters in the new line. */ |
| /* if 'expandtab' isn't set: use TABs */ |
| if (!curbuf->b_p_et) |
| { |
| /* If 'preserveindent' is set then reuse as much as possible of |
| * the existing indent structure for the new indent */ |
| if (!(flags & SIN_INSERT) && curbuf->b_p_pi) |
| { |
| p = oldline; |
| ind_done = 0; |
| |
| while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*p)) |
| { |
| if (*p == TAB) |
| { |
| tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts |
| - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| /* stop if this tab will overshoot the target */ |
| if (todo < tab_pad) |
| break; |
| todo -= tab_pad; |
| ind_done += tab_pad; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| --todo; |
| ++ind_done; |
| } |
| *s++ = *p++; |
| } |
| |
| /* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */ |
| tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| if (todo >= tab_pad) |
| { |
| *s++ = TAB; |
| todo -= tab_pad; |
| } |
| |
| p = skipwhite(p); |
| } |
| |
| while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts) |
| { |
| *s++ = TAB; |
| todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; |
| } |
| } |
| while (todo > 0) |
| { |
| *s++ = ' '; |
| --todo; |
| } |
| mch_memmove(s, p, (size_t)line_len); |
| |
| /* Replace the line (unless undo fails). */ |
| if (!(flags & SIN_UNDO) || u_savesub(curwin->w_cursor.lnum) == OK) |
| { |
| ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, newline, FALSE); |
| if (flags & SIN_CHANGED) |
| changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0); |
| /* Correct saved cursor position if it's after the indent. */ |
| if (saved_cursor.lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum |
| && saved_cursor.col >= (colnr_T)(p - oldline)) |
| saved_cursor.col += ind_len - (colnr_T)(p - oldline); |
| retval = TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| vim_free(newline); |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = ind_len; |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Copy the indent from ptr to the current line (and fill to size) |
| * Leaves the cursor on the first non-blank in the line. |
| * Returns TRUE if the line was changed. |
| */ |
| static int |
| copy_indent(size, src) |
| int size; |
| char_u *src; |
| { |
| char_u *p = NULL; |
| char_u *line = NULL; |
| char_u *s; |
| int todo; |
| int ind_len; |
| int line_len = 0; |
| int tab_pad; |
| int ind_done; |
| int round; |
| |
| /* Round 1: compute the number of characters needed for the indent |
| * Round 2: copy the characters. */ |
| for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round) |
| { |
| todo = size; |
| ind_len = 0; |
| ind_done = 0; |
| s = src; |
| |
| /* Count/copy the usable portion of the source line */ |
| while (todo > 0 && vim_iswhite(*s)) |
| { |
| if (*s == TAB) |
| { |
| tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts |
| - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| /* Stop if this tab will overshoot the target */ |
| if (todo < tab_pad) |
| break; |
| todo -= tab_pad; |
| ind_done += tab_pad; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| --todo; |
| ++ind_done; |
| } |
| ++ind_len; |
| if (p != NULL) |
| *p++ = *s; |
| ++s; |
| } |
| |
| /* Fill to next tabstop with a tab, if possible */ |
| tab_pad = (int)curbuf->b_p_ts - (ind_done % (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| if (todo >= tab_pad && !curbuf->b_p_et) |
| { |
| todo -= tab_pad; |
| ++ind_len; |
| if (p != NULL) |
| *p++ = TAB; |
| } |
| |
| /* Add tabs required for indent */ |
| while (todo >= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts && !curbuf->b_p_et) |
| { |
| todo -= (int)curbuf->b_p_ts; |
| ++ind_len; |
| if (p != NULL) |
| *p++ = TAB; |
| } |
| |
| /* Count/add spaces required for indent */ |
| while (todo > 0) |
| { |
| --todo; |
| ++ind_len; |
| if (p != NULL) |
| *p++ = ' '; |
| } |
| |
| if (p == NULL) |
| { |
| /* Allocate memory for the result: the copied indent, new indent |
| * and the rest of the line. */ |
| line_len = (int)STRLEN(ml_get_curline()) + 1; |
| line = alloc(ind_len + line_len); |
| if (line == NULL) |
| return FALSE; |
| p = line; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Append the original line */ |
| mch_memmove(p, ml_get_curline(), (size_t)line_len); |
| |
| /* Replace the line */ |
| ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, line, FALSE); |
| |
| /* Put the cursor after the indent. */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = ind_len; |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the indent of the current line after a number. Return -1 if no |
| * number was found. Used for 'n' in 'formatoptions': numbered list. |
| * Since a pattern is used it can actually handle more than numbers. |
| */ |
| int |
| get_number_indent(lnum) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| colnr_T col; |
| pos_T pos; |
| |
| regmatch_T regmatch; |
| int lead_len = 0; /* length of comment leader */ |
| |
| if (lnum > curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) |
| return -1; |
| pos.lnum = 0; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| /* In format_lines() (i.e. not insert mode), fo+=q is needed too... */ |
| if ((State & INSERT) || has_format_option(FO_Q_COMS)) |
| lead_len = get_leader_len(ml_get(lnum), NULL, FALSE, TRUE); |
| #endif |
| regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(curbuf->b_p_flp, RE_MAGIC); |
| if (regmatch.regprog != NULL) |
| { |
| regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE; |
| |
| /* vim_regexec() expects a pointer to a line. This lets us |
| * start matching for the flp beyond any comment leader... */ |
| if (vim_regexec(®match, ml_get(lnum) + lead_len, (colnr_T)0)) |
| { |
| pos.lnum = lnum; |
| pos.col = (colnr_T)(*regmatch.endp - ml_get(lnum)); |
| #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT |
| pos.coladd = 0; |
| #endif |
| } |
| } |
| vim_free(regmatch.regprog); |
| |
| if (pos.lnum == 0 || *ml_get_pos(&pos) == NUL) |
| return -1; |
| getvcol(curwin, &pos, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| return (int)col; |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT) |
| |
| static int cin_is_cinword __ARGS((char_u *line)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE if the string "line" starts with a word from 'cinwords'. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_is_cinword(line) |
| char_u *line; |
| { |
| char_u *cinw; |
| char_u *cinw_buf; |
| int cinw_len; |
| int retval = FALSE; |
| int len; |
| |
| cinw_len = (int)STRLEN(curbuf->b_p_cinw) + 1; |
| cinw_buf = alloc((unsigned)cinw_len); |
| if (cinw_buf != NULL) |
| { |
| line = skipwhite(line); |
| for (cinw = curbuf->b_p_cinw; *cinw; ) |
| { |
| len = copy_option_part(&cinw, cinw_buf, cinw_len, ","); |
| if (STRNCMP(line, cinw_buf, len) == 0 |
| && (!vim_iswordc(line[len]) || !vim_iswordc(line[len - 1]))) |
| { |
| retval = TRUE; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| vim_free(cinw_buf); |
| } |
| return retval; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * open_line: Add a new line below or above the current line. |
| * |
| * For VREPLACE mode, we only add a new line when we get to the end of the |
| * file, otherwise we just start replacing the next line. |
| * |
| * Caller must take care of undo. Since VREPLACE may affect any number of |
| * lines however, it may call u_save_cursor() again when starting to change a |
| * new line. |
| * "flags": OPENLINE_DELSPACES delete spaces after cursor |
| * OPENLINE_DO_COM format comments |
| * OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL keep trailing spaces |
| * OPENLINE_MARKFIX adjust mark positions after the line break |
| * OPENLINE_COM_LIST format comments with list or 2nd line indent |
| * |
| * "second_line_indent": indent for after ^^D in Insert mode or if flag |
| * OPENLINE_COM_LIST |
| * |
| * Return TRUE for success, FALSE for failure |
| */ |
| int |
| open_line(dir, flags, second_line_indent) |
| int dir; /* FORWARD or BACKWARD */ |
| int flags; |
| int second_line_indent; |
| { |
| char_u *saved_line; /* copy of the original line */ |
| char_u *next_line = NULL; /* copy of the next line */ |
| char_u *p_extra = NULL; /* what goes to next line */ |
| int less_cols = 0; /* less columns for mark in new line */ |
| int less_cols_off = 0; /* columns to skip for mark adjust */ |
| pos_T old_cursor; /* old cursor position */ |
| int newcol = 0; /* new cursor column */ |
| int newindent = 0; /* auto-indent of the new line */ |
| int n; |
| int trunc_line = FALSE; /* truncate current line afterwards */ |
| int retval = FALSE; /* return value, default is FAIL */ |
| #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| int extra_len = 0; /* length of p_extra string */ |
| int lead_len; /* length of comment leader */ |
| char_u *lead_flags; /* position in 'comments' for comment leader */ |
| char_u *leader = NULL; /* copy of comment leader */ |
| #endif |
| char_u *allocated = NULL; /* allocated memory */ |
| #if defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT) || defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_LISP) \ |
| || defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) |
| char_u *p; |
| #endif |
| int saved_char = NUL; /* init for GCC */ |
| #if defined(FEAT_SMARTINDENT) || defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) |
| pos_T *pos; |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| int do_si = (!p_paste && curbuf->b_p_si |
| # ifdef FEAT_CINDENT |
| && !curbuf->b_p_cin |
| # endif |
| ); |
| int no_si = FALSE; /* reset did_si afterwards */ |
| int first_char = NUL; /* init for GCC */ |
| #endif |
| #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT)) |
| int vreplace_mode; |
| #endif |
| int did_append; /* appended a new line */ |
| int saved_pi = curbuf->b_p_pi; /* copy of preserveindent setting */ |
| |
| /* |
| * make a copy of the current line so we can mess with it |
| */ |
| saved_line = vim_strsave(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (saved_line == NULL) /* out of memory! */ |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE |
| if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG) |
| { |
| /* |
| * With VREPLACE we make a copy of the next line, which we will be |
| * starting to replace. First make the new line empty and let vim play |
| * with the indenting and comment leader to its heart's content. Then |
| * we grab what it ended up putting on the new line, put back the |
| * original line, and call ins_char() to put each new character onto |
| * the line, replacing what was there before and pushing the right |
| * stuff onto the replace stack. -- webb. |
| */ |
| if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum < orig_line_count) |
| next_line = vim_strsave(ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1)); |
| else |
| next_line = vim_strsave((char_u *)""); |
| if (next_line == NULL) /* out of memory! */ |
| goto theend; |
| |
| /* |
| * In VREPLACE mode, a NL replaces the rest of the line, and starts |
| * replacing the next line, so push all of the characters left on the |
| * line onto the replace stack. We'll push any other characters that |
| * might be replaced at the start of the next line (due to autoindent |
| * etc) a bit later. |
| */ |
| replace_push(NUL); /* Call twice because BS over NL expects it */ |
| replace_push(NUL); |
| p = saved_line + curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| while (*p != NUL) |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| p += replace_push_mb(p); |
| else |
| #endif |
| replace_push(*p++); |
| } |
| saved_line[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| if ((State & INSERT) |
| #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE |
| && !(State & VREPLACE_FLAG) |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| p_extra = saved_line + curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| if (do_si) /* need first char after new line break */ |
| { |
| p = skipwhite(p_extra); |
| first_char = *p; |
| } |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| extra_len = (int)STRLEN(p_extra); |
| #endif |
| saved_char = *p_extra; |
| *p_extra = NUL; |
| } |
| |
| u_clearline(); /* cannot do "U" command when adding lines */ |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| did_si = FALSE; |
| #endif |
| ai_col = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * If we just did an auto-indent, then we didn't type anything on |
| * the prior line, and it should be truncated. Do this even if 'ai' is not |
| * set because automatically inserting a comment leader also sets did_ai. |
| */ |
| if (dir == FORWARD && did_ai) |
| trunc_line = TRUE; |
| |
| /* |
| * If 'autoindent' and/or 'smartindent' is set, try to figure out what |
| * indent to use for the new line. |
| */ |
| if (curbuf->b_p_ai |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| || do_si |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| /* |
| * count white space on current line |
| */ |
| newindent = get_indent_str(saved_line, (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| if (newindent == 0 && !(flags & OPENLINE_COM_LIST)) |
| newindent = second_line_indent; /* for ^^D command in insert mode */ |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| /* |
| * Do smart indenting. |
| * In insert/replace mode (only when dir == FORWARD) |
| * we may move some text to the next line. If it starts with '{' |
| * don't add an indent. Fixes inserting a NL before '{' in line |
| * "if (condition) {" |
| */ |
| if (!trunc_line && do_si && *saved_line != NUL |
| && (p_extra == NULL || first_char != '{')) |
| { |
| char_u *ptr; |
| char_u last_char; |
| |
| old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor; |
| ptr = saved_line; |
| # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM) |
| lead_len = get_leader_len(ptr, NULL, FALSE, TRUE); |
| else |
| lead_len = 0; |
| # endif |
| if (dir == FORWARD) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Skip preprocessor directives, unless they are |
| * recognised as comments. |
| */ |
| if ( |
| # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| lead_len == 0 && |
| # endif |
| ptr[0] == '#') |
| { |
| while (ptr[0] == '#' && curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) |
| ptr = ml_get(--curwin->w_cursor.lnum); |
| newindent = get_indent(); |
| } |
| # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM) |
| lead_len = get_leader_len(ptr, NULL, FALSE, TRUE); |
| else |
| lead_len = 0; |
| if (lead_len > 0) |
| { |
| /* |
| * This case gets the following right: |
| * \* |
| * * A comment (read '\' as '/'). |
| * *\ |
| * #define IN_THE_WAY |
| * This should line up here; |
| */ |
| p = skipwhite(ptr); |
| if (p[0] == '/' && p[1] == '*') |
| p++; |
| if (p[0] == '*') |
| { |
| for (p++; *p; p++) |
| { |
| if (p[0] == '/' && p[-1] == '*') |
| { |
| /* |
| * End of C comment, indent should line up |
| * with the line containing the start of |
| * the comment |
| */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(p - ptr); |
| if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, NUL)) != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; |
| newindent = get_indent(); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| else /* Not a comment line */ |
| # endif |
| { |
| /* Find last non-blank in line */ |
| p = ptr + STRLEN(ptr) - 1; |
| while (p > ptr && vim_iswhite(*p)) |
| --p; |
| last_char = *p; |
| |
| /* |
| * find the character just before the '{' or ';' |
| */ |
| if (last_char == '{' || last_char == ';') |
| { |
| if (p > ptr) |
| --p; |
| while (p > ptr && vim_iswhite(*p)) |
| --p; |
| } |
| /* |
| * Try to catch lines that are split over multiple |
| * lines. eg: |
| * if (condition && |
| * condition) { |
| * Should line up here! |
| * } |
| */ |
| if (*p == ')') |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(p - ptr); |
| if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, '(')) != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; |
| newindent = get_indent(); |
| ptr = ml_get_curline(); |
| } |
| } |
| /* |
| * If last character is '{' do indent, without |
| * checking for "if" and the like. |
| */ |
| if (last_char == '{') |
| { |
| did_si = TRUE; /* do indent */ |
| no_si = TRUE; /* don't delete it when '{' typed */ |
| } |
| /* |
| * Look for "if" and the like, use 'cinwords'. |
| * Don't do this if the previous line ended in ';' or |
| * '}'. |
| */ |
| else if (last_char != ';' && last_char != '}' |
| && cin_is_cinword(ptr)) |
| did_si = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| else /* dir == BACKWARD */ |
| { |
| /* |
| * Skip preprocessor directives, unless they are |
| * recognised as comments. |
| */ |
| if ( |
| # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| lead_len == 0 && |
| # endif |
| ptr[0] == '#') |
| { |
| int was_backslashed = FALSE; |
| |
| while ((ptr[0] == '#' || was_backslashed) && |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum < curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) |
| { |
| if (*ptr && ptr[STRLEN(ptr) - 1] == '\\') |
| was_backslashed = TRUE; |
| else |
| was_backslashed = FALSE; |
| ptr = ml_get(++curwin->w_cursor.lnum); |
| } |
| if (was_backslashed) |
| newindent = 0; /* Got to end of file */ |
| else |
| newindent = get_indent(); |
| } |
| p = skipwhite(ptr); |
| if (*p == '}') /* if line starts with '}': do indent */ |
| did_si = TRUE; |
| else /* can delete indent when '{' typed */ |
| can_si_back = TRUE; |
| } |
| curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor; |
| } |
| if (do_si) |
| can_si = TRUE; |
| #endif /* FEAT_SMARTINDENT */ |
| |
| did_ai = TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| /* |
| * Find out if the current line starts with a comment leader. |
| * This may then be inserted in front of the new line. |
| */ |
| end_comment_pending = NUL; |
| if (flags & OPENLINE_DO_COM) |
| lead_len = get_leader_len(saved_line, &lead_flags, dir == BACKWARD, TRUE); |
| else |
| lead_len = 0; |
| if (lead_len > 0) |
| { |
| char_u *lead_repl = NULL; /* replaces comment leader */ |
| int lead_repl_len = 0; /* length of *lead_repl */ |
| char_u lead_middle[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* middle-comment string */ |
| char_u lead_end[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* end-comment string */ |
| char_u *comment_end = NULL; /* where lead_end has been found */ |
| int extra_space = FALSE; /* append extra space */ |
| int current_flag; |
| int require_blank = FALSE; /* requires blank after middle */ |
| char_u *p2; |
| |
| /* |
| * If the comment leader has the start, middle or end flag, it may not |
| * be used or may be replaced with the middle leader. |
| */ |
| for (p = lead_flags; *p && *p != ':'; ++p) |
| { |
| if (*p == COM_BLANK) |
| { |
| require_blank = TRUE; |
| continue; |
| } |
| if (*p == COM_START || *p == COM_MIDDLE) |
| { |
| current_flag = *p; |
| if (*p == COM_START) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Doing "O" on a start of comment does not insert leader. |
| */ |
| if (dir == BACKWARD) |
| { |
| lead_len = 0; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* find start of middle part */ |
| (void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_middle, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); |
| require_blank = FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Isolate the strings of the middle and end leader. |
| */ |
| while (*p && p[-1] != ':') /* find end of middle flags */ |
| { |
| if (*p == COM_BLANK) |
| require_blank = TRUE; |
| ++p; |
| } |
| (void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_middle, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); |
| |
| while (*p && p[-1] != ':') /* find end of end flags */ |
| { |
| /* Check whether we allow automatic ending of comments */ |
| if (*p == COM_AUTO_END) |
| end_comment_pending = -1; /* means we want to set it */ |
| ++p; |
| } |
| n = copy_option_part(&p, lead_end, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); |
| |
| if (end_comment_pending == -1) /* we can set it now */ |
| end_comment_pending = lead_end[n - 1]; |
| |
| /* |
| * If the end of the comment is in the same line, don't use |
| * the comment leader. |
| */ |
| if (dir == FORWARD) |
| { |
| for (p = saved_line + lead_len; *p; ++p) |
| if (STRNCMP(p, lead_end, n) == 0) |
| { |
| comment_end = p; |
| lead_len = 0; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Doing "o" on a start of comment inserts the middle leader. |
| */ |
| if (lead_len > 0) |
| { |
| if (current_flag == COM_START) |
| { |
| lead_repl = lead_middle; |
| lead_repl_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_middle); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If we have hit RETURN immediately after the start |
| * comment leader, then put a space after the middle |
| * comment leader on the next line. |
| */ |
| if (!vim_iswhite(saved_line[lead_len - 1]) |
| && ((p_extra != NULL |
| && (int)curwin->w_cursor.col == lead_len) |
| || (p_extra == NULL |
| && saved_line[lead_len] == NUL) |
| || require_blank)) |
| extra_space = TRUE; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| if (*p == COM_END) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Doing "o" on the end of a comment does not insert leader. |
| * Remember where the end is, might want to use it to find the |
| * start (for C-comments). |
| */ |
| if (dir == FORWARD) |
| { |
| comment_end = skipwhite(saved_line); |
| lead_len = 0; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Doing "O" on the end of a comment inserts the middle leader. |
| * Find the string for the middle leader, searching backwards. |
| */ |
| while (p > curbuf->b_p_com && *p != ',') |
| --p; |
| for (lead_repl = p; lead_repl > curbuf->b_p_com |
| && lead_repl[-1] != ':'; --lead_repl) |
| ; |
| lead_repl_len = (int)(p - lead_repl); |
| |
| /* We can probably always add an extra space when doing "O" on |
| * the comment-end */ |
| extra_space = TRUE; |
| |
| /* Check whether we allow automatic ending of comments */ |
| for (p2 = p; *p2 && *p2 != ':'; p2++) |
| { |
| if (*p2 == COM_AUTO_END) |
| end_comment_pending = -1; /* means we want to set it */ |
| } |
| if (end_comment_pending == -1) |
| { |
| /* Find last character in end-comment string */ |
| while (*p2 && *p2 != ',') |
| p2++; |
| end_comment_pending = p2[-1]; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| if (*p == COM_FIRST) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Comment leader for first line only: Don't repeat leader |
| * when using "O", blank out leader when using "o". |
| */ |
| if (dir == BACKWARD) |
| lead_len = 0; |
| else |
| { |
| lead_repl = (char_u *)""; |
| lead_repl_len = 0; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| if (lead_len) |
| { |
| /* allocate buffer (may concatenate p_extra later) */ |
| leader = alloc(lead_len + lead_repl_len + extra_space + extra_len |
| + (second_line_indent > 0 ? second_line_indent : 0) + 1); |
| allocated = leader; /* remember to free it later */ |
| |
| if (leader == NULL) |
| lead_len = 0; |
| else |
| { |
| vim_strncpy(leader, saved_line, lead_len); |
| |
| /* |
| * Replace leader with lead_repl, right or left adjusted |
| */ |
| if (lead_repl != NULL) |
| { |
| int c = 0; |
| int off = 0; |
| |
| for (p = lead_flags; *p != NUL && *p != ':'; ) |
| { |
| if (*p == COM_RIGHT || *p == COM_LEFT) |
| c = *p++; |
| else if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p) || *p == '-') |
| off = getdigits(&p); |
| else |
| ++p; |
| } |
| if (c == COM_RIGHT) /* right adjusted leader */ |
| { |
| /* find last non-white in the leader to line up with */ |
| for (p = leader + lead_len - 1; p > leader |
| && vim_iswhite(*p); --p) |
| ; |
| ++p; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| /* Compute the length of the replaced characters in |
| * screen characters, not bytes. */ |
| { |
| int repl_size = vim_strnsize(lead_repl, |
| lead_repl_len); |
| int old_size = 0; |
| char_u *endp = p; |
| int l; |
| |
| while (old_size < repl_size && p > leader) |
| { |
| mb_ptr_back(leader, p); |
| old_size += ptr2cells(p); |
| } |
| l = lead_repl_len - (int)(endp - p); |
| if (l != 0) |
| mch_memmove(endp + l, endp, |
| (size_t)((leader + lead_len) - endp)); |
| lead_len += l; |
| } |
| #else |
| if (p < leader + lead_repl_len) |
| p = leader; |
| else |
| p -= lead_repl_len; |
| #endif |
| mch_memmove(p, lead_repl, (size_t)lead_repl_len); |
| if (p + lead_repl_len > leader + lead_len) |
| p[lead_repl_len] = NUL; |
| |
| /* blank-out any other chars from the old leader. */ |
| while (--p >= leader) |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| int l = mb_head_off(leader, p); |
| |
| if (l > 1) |
| { |
| p -= l; |
| if (ptr2cells(p) > 1) |
| { |
| p[1] = ' '; |
| --l; |
| } |
| mch_memmove(p + 1, p + l + 1, |
| (size_t)((leader + lead_len) - (p + l + 1))); |
| lead_len -= l; |
| *p = ' '; |
| } |
| else |
| #endif |
| if (!vim_iswhite(*p)) |
| *p = ' '; |
| } |
| } |
| else /* left adjusted leader */ |
| { |
| p = skipwhite(leader); |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| /* Compute the length of the replaced characters in |
| * screen characters, not bytes. Move the part that is |
| * not to be overwritten. */ |
| { |
| int repl_size = vim_strnsize(lead_repl, |
| lead_repl_len); |
| int i; |
| int l; |
| |
| for (i = 0; p[i] != NUL && i < lead_len; i += l) |
| { |
| l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p + i); |
| if (vim_strnsize(p, i + l) > repl_size) |
| break; |
| } |
| if (i != lead_repl_len) |
| { |
| mch_memmove(p + lead_repl_len, p + i, |
| (size_t)(lead_len - i - (p - leader))); |
| lead_len += lead_repl_len - i; |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| mch_memmove(p, lead_repl, (size_t)lead_repl_len); |
| |
| /* Replace any remaining non-white chars in the old |
| * leader by spaces. Keep Tabs, the indent must |
| * remain the same. */ |
| for (p += lead_repl_len; p < leader + lead_len; ++p) |
| if (!vim_iswhite(*p)) |
| { |
| /* Don't put a space before a TAB. */ |
| if (p + 1 < leader + lead_len && p[1] == TAB) |
| { |
| --lead_len; |
| mch_memmove(p, p + 1, |
| (leader + lead_len) - p); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| int l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p); |
| |
| if (l > 1) |
| { |
| if (ptr2cells(p) > 1) |
| { |
| /* Replace a double-wide char with |
| * two spaces */ |
| --l; |
| *p++ = ' '; |
| } |
| mch_memmove(p + 1, p + l, |
| (leader + lead_len) - p); |
| lead_len -= l - 1; |
| } |
| #endif |
| *p = ' '; |
| } |
| } |
| *p = NUL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Recompute the indent, it may have changed. */ |
| if (curbuf->b_p_ai |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| || do_si |
| #endif |
| ) |
| newindent = get_indent_str(leader, (int)curbuf->b_p_ts); |
| |
| /* Add the indent offset */ |
| if (newindent + off < 0) |
| { |
| off = -newindent; |
| newindent = 0; |
| } |
| else |
| newindent += off; |
| |
| /* Correct trailing spaces for the shift, so that |
| * alignment remains equal. */ |
| while (off > 0 && lead_len > 0 |
| && leader[lead_len - 1] == ' ') |
| { |
| /* Don't do it when there is a tab before the space */ |
| if (vim_strchr(skipwhite(leader), '\t') != NULL) |
| break; |
| --lead_len; |
| --off; |
| } |
| |
| /* If the leader ends in white space, don't add an |
| * extra space */ |
| if (lead_len > 0 && vim_iswhite(leader[lead_len - 1])) |
| extra_space = FALSE; |
| leader[lead_len] = NUL; |
| } |
| |
| if (extra_space) |
| { |
| leader[lead_len++] = ' '; |
| leader[lead_len] = NUL; |
| } |
| |
| newcol = lead_len; |
| |
| /* |
| * if a new indent will be set below, remove the indent that |
| * is in the comment leader |
| */ |
| if (newindent |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| || did_si |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| while (lead_len && vim_iswhite(*leader)) |
| { |
| --lead_len; |
| --newcol; |
| ++leader; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| } |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| did_si = can_si = FALSE; |
| #endif |
| } |
| else if (comment_end != NULL) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We have finished a comment, so we don't use the leader. |
| * If this was a C-comment and 'ai' or 'si' is set do a normal |
| * indent to align with the line containing the start of the |
| * comment. |
| */ |
| if (comment_end[0] == '*' && comment_end[1] == '/' && |
| (curbuf->b_p_ai |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| || do_si |
| #endif |
| )) |
| { |
| old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = (colnr_T)(comment_end - saved_line); |
| if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, NUL)) != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; |
| newindent = get_indent(); |
| } |
| curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* (State == INSERT || State == REPLACE), only when dir == FORWARD */ |
| if (p_extra != NULL) |
| { |
| *p_extra = saved_char; /* restore char that NUL replaced */ |
| |
| /* |
| * When 'ai' set or "flags" has OPENLINE_DELSPACES, skip to the first |
| * non-blank. |
| * |
| * When in REPLACE mode, put the deleted blanks on the replace stack, |
| * preceded by a NUL, so they can be put back when a BS is entered. |
| */ |
| if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State)) |
| replace_push(NUL); /* end of extra blanks */ |
| if (curbuf->b_p_ai || (flags & OPENLINE_DELSPACES)) |
| { |
| while ((*p_extra == ' ' || *p_extra == '\t') |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| && (!enc_utf8 |
| || !utf_iscomposing(utf_ptr2char(p_extra + 1))) |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State)) |
| replace_push(*p_extra); |
| ++p_extra; |
| ++less_cols_off; |
| } |
| } |
| if (*p_extra != NUL) |
| did_ai = FALSE; /* append some text, don't truncate now */ |
| |
| /* columns for marks adjusted for removed columns */ |
| less_cols = (int)(p_extra - saved_line); |
| } |
| |
| if (p_extra == NULL) |
| p_extra = (char_u *)""; /* append empty line */ |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| /* concatenate leader and p_extra, if there is a leader */ |
| if (lead_len) |
| { |
| if (flags & OPENLINE_COM_LIST && second_line_indent > 0) |
| { |
| int i; |
| int padding = second_line_indent |
| - (newindent + (int)STRLEN(leader)); |
| |
| /* Here whitespace is inserted after the comment char. |
| * Below, set_indent(newindent, SIN_INSERT) will insert the |
| * whitespace needed before the comment char. */ |
| for (i = 0; i < padding; i++) |
| { |
| STRCAT(leader, " "); |
| less_cols--; |
| newcol++; |
| } |
| } |
| STRCAT(leader, p_extra); |
| p_extra = leader; |
| did_ai = TRUE; /* So truncating blanks works with comments */ |
| less_cols -= lead_len; |
| } |
| else |
| end_comment_pending = NUL; /* turns out there was no leader */ |
| #endif |
| |
| old_cursor = curwin->w_cursor; |
| if (dir == BACKWARD) |
| --curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE |
| if (!(State & VREPLACE_FLAG) || old_cursor.lnum >= orig_line_count) |
| #endif |
| { |
| if (ml_append(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, p_extra, (colnr_T)0, FALSE) |
| == FAIL) |
| goto theend; |
| /* Postpone calling changed_lines(), because it would mess up folding |
| * with markers. */ |
| mark_adjust(curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1, (linenr_T)MAXLNUM, 1L, 0L); |
| did_append = TRUE; |
| } |
| #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * In VREPLACE mode we are starting to replace the next line. |
| */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum++; |
| if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum >= Insstart.lnum + vr_lines_changed) |
| { |
| /* In case we NL to a new line, BS to the previous one, and NL |
| * again, we don't want to save the new line for undo twice. |
| */ |
| (void)u_save_cursor(); /* errors are ignored! */ |
| vr_lines_changed++; |
| } |
| ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, p_extra, TRUE); |
| changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0); |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum--; |
| did_append = FALSE; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| if (newindent |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| || did_si |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| if (did_si) |
| { |
| int sw = (int)get_sw_value(); |
| |
| if (p_sr) |
| newindent -= newindent % sw; |
| newindent += sw; |
| } |
| #endif |
| /* Copy the indent */ |
| if (curbuf->b_p_ci) |
| { |
| (void)copy_indent(newindent, saved_line); |
| |
| /* |
| * Set the 'preserveindent' option so that any further screwing |
| * with the line doesn't entirely destroy our efforts to preserve |
| * it. It gets restored at the function end. |
| */ |
| curbuf->b_p_pi = TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| (void)set_indent(newindent, SIN_INSERT); |
| less_cols -= curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| |
| ai_col = curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| |
| /* |
| * In REPLACE mode, for each character in the new indent, there must |
| * be a NUL on the replace stack, for when it is deleted with BS |
| */ |
| if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State)) |
| for (n = 0; n < (int)curwin->w_cursor.col; ++n) |
| replace_push(NUL); |
| newcol += curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| #ifdef FEAT_SMARTINDENT |
| if (no_si) |
| did_si = FALSE; |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| /* |
| * In REPLACE mode, for each character in the extra leader, there must be |
| * a NUL on the replace stack, for when it is deleted with BS. |
| */ |
| if (REPLACE_NORMAL(State)) |
| while (lead_len-- > 0) |
| replace_push(NUL); |
| #endif |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor = old_cursor; |
| |
| if (dir == FORWARD) |
| { |
| if (trunc_line || (State & INSERT)) |
| { |
| /* truncate current line at cursor */ |
| saved_line[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL; |
| /* Remove trailing white space, unless OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL used. */ |
| if (trunc_line && !(flags & OPENLINE_KEEPTRAIL)) |
| truncate_spaces(saved_line); |
| ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, saved_line, FALSE); |
| saved_line = NULL; |
| if (did_append) |
| { |
| changed_lines(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col, |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum + 1, 1L); |
| did_append = FALSE; |
| |
| /* Move marks after the line break to the new line. */ |
| if (flags & OPENLINE_MARKFIX) |
| mark_col_adjust(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, |
| curwin->w_cursor.col + less_cols_off, |
| 1L, (long)-less_cols); |
| } |
| else |
| changed_bytes(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Put the cursor on the new line. Careful: the scrollup() above may |
| * have moved w_cursor, we must use old_cursor. |
| */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = old_cursor.lnum + 1; |
| } |
| if (did_append) |
| changed_lines(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 1L); |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = newcol; |
| #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT |
| curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0; |
| #endif |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT)) |
| /* |
| * In VREPLACE mode, we are handling the replace stack ourselves, so stop |
| * fixthisline() from doing it (via change_indent()) by telling it we're in |
| * normal INSERT mode. |
| */ |
| if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG) |
| { |
| vreplace_mode = State; /* So we know to put things right later */ |
| State = INSERT; |
| } |
| else |
| vreplace_mode = 0; |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_LISP |
| /* |
| * May do lisp indenting. |
| */ |
| if (!p_paste |
| # ifdef FEAT_COMMENTS |
| && leader == NULL |
| # endif |
| && curbuf->b_p_lisp |
| && curbuf->b_p_ai) |
| { |
| fixthisline(get_lisp_indent); |
| p = ml_get_curline(); |
| ai_col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(p) - p); |
| } |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_CINDENT |
| /* |
| * May do indenting after opening a new line. |
| */ |
| if (!p_paste |
| && (curbuf->b_p_cin |
| # ifdef FEAT_EVAL |
| || *curbuf->b_p_inde != NUL |
| # endif |
| ) |
| && in_cinkeys(dir == FORWARD |
| ? KEY_OPEN_FORW |
| : KEY_OPEN_BACK, ' ', linewhite(curwin->w_cursor.lnum))) |
| { |
| do_c_expr_indent(); |
| p = ml_get_curline(); |
| ai_col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(p) - p); |
| } |
| #endif |
| #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) && (defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(FEAT_CINDENT)) |
| if (vreplace_mode != 0) |
| State = vreplace_mode; |
| #endif |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE |
| /* |
| * Finally, VREPLACE gets the stuff on the new line, then puts back the |
| * original line, and inserts the new stuff char by char, pushing old stuff |
| * onto the replace stack (via ins_char()). |
| */ |
| if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG) |
| { |
| /* Put new line in p_extra */ |
| p_extra = vim_strsave(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (p_extra == NULL) |
| goto theend; |
| |
| /* Put back original line */ |
| ml_replace(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, next_line, FALSE); |
| |
| /* Insert new stuff into line again */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT |
| curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0; |
| #endif |
| ins_bytes(p_extra); /* will call changed_bytes() */ |
| vim_free(p_extra); |
| next_line = NULL; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| retval = TRUE; /* success! */ |
| theend: |
| curbuf->b_p_pi = saved_pi; |
| vim_free(saved_line); |
| vim_free(next_line); |
| vim_free(allocated); |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * get_leader_len() returns the length of the prefix of the given string |
| * which introduces a comment. If this string is not a comment then 0 is |
| * returned. |
| * When "flags" is not NULL, it is set to point to the flags of the recognized |
| * comment leader. |
| * "backward" must be true for the "O" command. |
| * If "include_space" is set, include trailing whitespace while calculating the |
| * length. |
| */ |
| int |
| get_leader_len(line, flags, backward, include_space) |
| char_u *line; |
| char_u **flags; |
| int backward; |
| int include_space; |
| { |
| int i, j; |
| int result; |
| int got_com = FALSE; |
| int found_one; |
| char_u part_buf[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* buffer for one option part */ |
| char_u *string; /* pointer to comment string */ |
| char_u *list; |
| int middle_match_len = 0; |
| char_u *prev_list; |
| char_u *saved_flags = NULL; |
| |
| result = i = 0; |
| while (vim_iswhite(line[i])) /* leading white space is ignored */ |
| ++i; |
| |
| /* |
| * Repeat to match several nested comment strings. |
| */ |
| while (line[i] != NUL) |
| { |
| /* |
| * scan through the 'comments' option for a match |
| */ |
| found_one = FALSE; |
| for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; ) |
| { |
| /* Get one option part into part_buf[]. Advance "list" to next |
| * one. Put "string" at start of string. */ |
| if (!got_com && flags != NULL) |
| *flags = list; /* remember where flags started */ |
| prev_list = list; |
| (void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); |
| string = vim_strchr(part_buf, ':'); |
| if (string == NULL) /* missing ':', ignore this part */ |
| continue; |
| *string++ = NUL; /* isolate flags from string */ |
| |
| /* If we found a middle match previously, use that match when this |
| * is not a middle or end. */ |
| if (middle_match_len != 0 |
| && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_MIDDLE) == NULL |
| && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_END) == NULL) |
| break; |
| |
| /* When we already found a nested comment, only accept further |
| * nested comments. */ |
| if (got_com && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) == NULL) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* When 'O' flag present and using "O" command skip this one. */ |
| if (backward && vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NOBACK) != NULL) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Line contents and string must match. |
| * When string starts with white space, must have some white space |
| * (but the amount does not need to match, there might be a mix of |
| * TABs and spaces). */ |
| if (vim_iswhite(string[0])) |
| { |
| if (i == 0 || !vim_iswhite(line[i - 1])) |
| continue; /* missing shite space */ |
| while (vim_iswhite(string[0])) |
| ++string; |
| } |
| for (j = 0; string[j] != NUL && string[j] == line[i + j]; ++j) |
| ; |
| if (string[j] != NUL) |
| continue; /* string doesn't match */ |
| |
| /* When 'b' flag used, there must be white space or an |
| * end-of-line after the string in the line. */ |
| if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_BLANK) != NULL |
| && !vim_iswhite(line[i + j]) && line[i + j] != NUL) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* We have found a match, stop searching unless this is a middle |
| * comment. The middle comment can be a substring of the end |
| * comment in which case it's better to return the length of the |
| * end comment and its flags. Thus we keep searching with middle |
| * and end matches and use an end match if it matches better. */ |
| if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_MIDDLE) != NULL) |
| { |
| if (middle_match_len == 0) |
| { |
| middle_match_len = j; |
| saved_flags = prev_list; |
| } |
| continue; |
| } |
| if (middle_match_len != 0 && j > middle_match_len) |
| /* Use this match instead of the middle match, since it's a |
| * longer thus better match. */ |
| middle_match_len = 0; |
| |
| if (middle_match_len == 0) |
| i += j; |
| found_one = TRUE; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (middle_match_len != 0) |
| { |
| /* Use the previously found middle match after failing to find a |
| * match with an end. */ |
| if (!got_com && flags != NULL) |
| *flags = saved_flags; |
| i += middle_match_len; |
| found_one = TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /* No match found, stop scanning. */ |
| if (!found_one) |
| break; |
| |
| result = i; |
| |
| /* Include any trailing white space. */ |
| while (vim_iswhite(line[i])) |
| ++i; |
| |
| if (include_space) |
| result = i; |
| |
| /* If this comment doesn't nest, stop here. */ |
| got_com = TRUE; |
| if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) == NULL) |
| break; |
| } |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the offset at which the last comment in line starts. If there is no |
| * comment in the whole line, -1 is returned. |
| * |
| * When "flags" is not null, it is set to point to the flags describing the |
| * recognized comment leader. |
| */ |
| int |
| get_last_leader_offset(line, flags) |
| char_u *line; |
| char_u **flags; |
| { |
| int result = -1; |
| int i, j; |
| int lower_check_bound = 0; |
| char_u *string; |
| char_u *com_leader; |
| char_u *com_flags; |
| char_u *list; |
| int found_one; |
| char_u part_buf[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* buffer for one option part */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Repeat to match several nested comment strings. |
| */ |
| i = (int)STRLEN(line); |
| while (--i >= lower_check_bound) |
| { |
| /* |
| * scan through the 'comments' option for a match |
| */ |
| found_one = FALSE; |
| for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; ) |
| { |
| char_u *flags_save = list; |
| |
| /* |
| * Get one option part into part_buf[]. Advance list to next one. |
| * put string at start of string. |
| */ |
| (void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); |
| string = vim_strchr(part_buf, ':'); |
| if (string == NULL) /* If everything is fine, this cannot actually |
| * happen. */ |
| { |
| continue; |
| } |
| *string++ = NUL; /* Isolate flags from string. */ |
| com_leader = string; |
| |
| /* |
| * Line contents and string must match. |
| * When string starts with white space, must have some white space |
| * (but the amount does not need to match, there might be a mix of |
| * TABs and spaces). |
| */ |
| if (vim_iswhite(string[0])) |
| { |
| if (i == 0 || !vim_iswhite(line[i - 1])) |
| continue; |
| while (vim_iswhite(string[0])) |
| ++string; |
| } |
| for (j = 0; string[j] != NUL && string[j] == line[i + j]; ++j) |
| /* do nothing */; |
| if (string[j] != NUL) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* |
| * When 'b' flag used, there must be white space or an |
| * end-of-line after the string in the line. |
| */ |
| if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_BLANK) != NULL |
| && !vim_iswhite(line[i + j]) && line[i + j] != NUL) |
| { |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * We have found a match, stop searching. |
| */ |
| found_one = TRUE; |
| |
| if (flags) |
| *flags = flags_save; |
| com_flags = flags_save; |
| |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (found_one) |
| { |
| char_u part_buf2[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* buffer for one option part */ |
| int len1, len2, off; |
| |
| result = i; |
| /* |
| * If this comment nests, continue searching. |
| */ |
| if (vim_strchr(part_buf, COM_NEST) != NULL) |
| continue; |
| |
| lower_check_bound = i; |
| |
| /* Let's verify whether the comment leader found is a substring |
| * of other comment leaders. If it is, let's adjust the |
| * lower_check_bound so that we make sure that we have determined |
| * the comment leader correctly. |
| */ |
| |
| while (vim_iswhite(*com_leader)) |
| ++com_leader; |
| len1 = (int)STRLEN(com_leader); |
| |
| for (list = curbuf->b_p_com; *list; ) |
| { |
| char_u *flags_save = list; |
| |
| (void)copy_option_part(&list, part_buf2, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); |
| if (flags_save == com_flags) |
| continue; |
| string = vim_strchr(part_buf2, ':'); |
| ++string; |
| while (vim_iswhite(*string)) |
| ++string; |
| len2 = (int)STRLEN(string); |
| if (len2 == 0) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Now we have to verify whether string ends with a substring |
| * beginning the com_leader. */ |
| for (off = (len2 > i ? i : len2); off > 0 && off + len1 > len2;) |
| { |
| --off; |
| if (!STRNCMP(string + off, com_leader, len2 - off)) |
| { |
| if (i - off < lower_check_bound) |
| lower_check_bound = i - off; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| return result; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the number of window lines occupied by buffer line "lnum". |
| */ |
| int |
| plines(lnum) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| return plines_win(curwin, lnum, TRUE); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| plines_win(wp, lnum, winheight) |
| win_T *wp; |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| int winheight; /* when TRUE limit to window height */ |
| { |
| #if defined(FEAT_DIFF) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* Check for filler lines above this buffer line. When folded the result |
| * is one line anyway. */ |
| return plines_win_nofill(wp, lnum, winheight) + diff_check_fill(wp, lnum); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| plines_nofill(lnum) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| return plines_win_nofill(curwin, lnum, TRUE); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| plines_win_nofill(wp, lnum, winheight) |
| win_T *wp; |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| int winheight; /* when TRUE limit to window height */ |
| { |
| #endif |
| int lines; |
| |
| if (!wp->w_p_wrap) |
| return 1; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_VERTSPLIT |
| if (wp->w_width == 0) |
| return 1; |
| #endif |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING |
| /* A folded lines is handled just like an empty line. */ |
| /* NOTE: Caller must handle lines that are MAYBE folded. */ |
| if (lineFolded(wp, lnum) == TRUE) |
| return 1; |
| #endif |
| |
| lines = plines_win_nofold(wp, lnum); |
| if (winheight > 0 && lines > wp->w_height) |
| return (int)wp->w_height; |
| return lines; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return number of window lines physical line "lnum" will occupy in window |
| * "wp". Does not care about folding, 'wrap' or 'diff'. |
| */ |
| int |
| plines_win_nofold(wp, lnum) |
| win_T *wp; |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| char_u *s; |
| long col; |
| int width; |
| |
| s = ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum, FALSE); |
| if (*s == NUL) /* empty line */ |
| return 1; |
| col = win_linetabsize(wp, s, (colnr_T)MAXCOL); |
| |
| /* |
| * If list mode is on, then the '$' at the end of the line may take up one |
| * extra column. |
| */ |
| if (wp->w_p_list && lcs_eol != NUL) |
| col += 1; |
| |
| /* |
| * Add column offset for 'number', 'relativenumber' and 'foldcolumn'. |
| */ |
| width = W_WIDTH(wp) - win_col_off(wp); |
| if (width <= 0) |
| return 32000; |
| if (col <= width) |
| return 1; |
| col -= width; |
| width += win_col_off2(wp); |
| return (col + (width - 1)) / width + 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Like plines_win(), but only reports the number of physical screen lines |
| * used from the start of the line to the given column number. |
| */ |
| int |
| plines_win_col(wp, lnum, column) |
| win_T *wp; |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| long column; |
| { |
| long col; |
| char_u *s; |
| int lines = 0; |
| int width; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_DIFF |
| /* Check for filler lines above this buffer line. When folded the result |
| * is one line anyway. */ |
| lines = diff_check_fill(wp, lnum); |
| #endif |
| |
| if (!wp->w_p_wrap) |
| return lines + 1; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_VERTSPLIT |
| if (wp->w_width == 0) |
| return lines + 1; |
| #endif |
| |
| s = ml_get_buf(wp->w_buffer, lnum, FALSE); |
| |
| col = 0; |
| while (*s != NUL && --column >= 0) |
| { |
| col += win_lbr_chartabsize(wp, s, (colnr_T)col, NULL); |
| mb_ptr_adv(s); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If *s is a TAB, and the TAB is not displayed as ^I, and we're not in |
| * INSERT mode, then col must be adjusted so that it represents the last |
| * screen position of the TAB. This only fixes an error when the TAB wraps |
| * from one screen line to the next (when 'columns' is not a multiple of |
| * 'ts') -- webb. |
| */ |
| if (*s == TAB && (State & NORMAL) && (!wp->w_p_list || lcs_tab1)) |
| col += win_lbr_chartabsize(wp, s, (colnr_T)col, NULL) - 1; |
| |
| /* |
| * Add column offset for 'number', 'relativenumber', 'foldcolumn', etc. |
| */ |
| width = W_WIDTH(wp) - win_col_off(wp); |
| if (width <= 0) |
| return 9999; |
| |
| lines += 1; |
| if (col > width) |
| lines += (col - width) / (width + win_col_off2(wp)) + 1; |
| return lines; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| plines_m_win(wp, first, last) |
| win_T *wp; |
| linenr_T first, last; |
| { |
| int count = 0; |
| |
| while (first <= last) |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING |
| int x; |
| |
| /* Check if there are any really folded lines, but also included lines |
| * that are maybe folded. */ |
| x = foldedCount(wp, first, NULL); |
| if (x > 0) |
| { |
| ++count; /* count 1 for "+-- folded" line */ |
| first += x; |
| } |
| else |
| #endif |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_DIFF |
| if (first == wp->w_topline) |
| count += plines_win_nofill(wp, first, TRUE) + wp->w_topfill; |
| else |
| #endif |
| count += plines_win(wp, first, TRUE); |
| ++first; |
| } |
| } |
| return (count); |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_INS_EXPAND) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Insert string "p" at the cursor position. Stops at a NUL byte. |
| * Handles Replace mode and multi-byte characters. |
| */ |
| void |
| ins_bytes(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| ins_bytes_len(p, (int)STRLEN(p)); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_VREPLACE) || defined(FEAT_INS_EXPAND) \ |
| || defined(FEAT_COMMENTS) || defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Insert string "p" with length "len" at the cursor position. |
| * Handles Replace mode and multi-byte characters. |
| */ |
| void |
| ins_bytes_len(p, len) |
| char_u *p; |
| int len; |
| { |
| int i; |
| # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| int n; |
| |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| for (i = 0; i < len; i += n) |
| { |
| if (enc_utf8) |
| /* avoid reading past p[len] */ |
| n = utfc_ptr2len_len(p + i, len - i); |
| else |
| n = (*mb_ptr2len)(p + i); |
| ins_char_bytes(p + i, n); |
| } |
| else |
| # endif |
| for (i = 0; i < len; ++i) |
| ins_char(p[i]); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Insert or replace a single character at the cursor position. |
| * When in REPLACE or VREPLACE mode, replace any existing character. |
| * Caller must have prepared for undo. |
| * For multi-byte characters we get the whole character, the caller must |
| * convert bytes to a character. |
| */ |
| void |
| ins_char(c) |
| int c; |
| { |
| #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO) |
| char_u buf[MB_MAXBYTES + 1]; |
| int n; |
| |
| n = (*mb_char2bytes)(c, buf); |
| |
| /* When "c" is 0x100, 0x200, etc. we don't want to insert a NUL byte. |
| * Happens for CTRL-Vu9900. */ |
| if (buf[0] == 0) |
| buf[0] = '\n'; |
| |
| ins_char_bytes(buf, n); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| ins_char_bytes(buf, charlen) |
| char_u *buf; |
| int charlen; |
| { |
| int c = buf[0]; |
| #endif |
| int newlen; /* nr of bytes inserted */ |
| int oldlen; /* nr of bytes deleted (0 when not replacing) */ |
| char_u *p; |
| char_u *newp; |
| char_u *oldp; |
| int linelen; /* length of old line including NUL */ |
| colnr_T col; |
| linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| int i; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT |
| /* Break tabs if needed. */ |
| if (virtual_active() && curwin->w_cursor.coladd > 0) |
| coladvance_force(getviscol()); |
| #endif |
| |
| col = curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| oldp = ml_get(lnum); |
| linelen = (int)STRLEN(oldp) + 1; |
| |
| /* The lengths default to the values for when not replacing. */ |
| oldlen = 0; |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| newlen = charlen; |
| #else |
| newlen = 1; |
| #endif |
| |
| if (State & REPLACE_FLAG) |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_VREPLACE |
| if (State & VREPLACE_FLAG) |
| { |
| colnr_T new_vcol = 0; /* init for GCC */ |
| colnr_T vcol; |
| int old_list; |
| #ifndef FEAT_MBYTE |
| char_u buf[2]; |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Disable 'list' temporarily, unless 'cpo' contains the 'L' flag. |
| * Returns the old value of list, so when finished, |
| * curwin->w_p_list should be set back to this. |
| */ |
| old_list = curwin->w_p_list; |
| if (old_list && vim_strchr(p_cpo, CPO_LISTWM) == NULL) |
| curwin->w_p_list = FALSE; |
| |
| /* |
| * In virtual replace mode each character may replace one or more |
| * characters (zero if it's a TAB). Count the number of bytes to |
| * be deleted to make room for the new character, counting screen |
| * cells. May result in adding spaces to fill a gap. |
| */ |
| getvcol(curwin, &curwin->w_cursor, NULL, &vcol, NULL); |
| #ifndef FEAT_MBYTE |
| buf[0] = c; |
| buf[1] = NUL; |
| #endif |
| new_vcol = vcol + chartabsize(buf, vcol); |
| while (oldp[col + oldlen] != NUL && vcol < new_vcol) |
| { |
| vcol += chartabsize(oldp + col + oldlen, vcol); |
| /* Don't need to remove a TAB that takes us to the right |
| * position. */ |
| if (vcol > new_vcol && oldp[col + oldlen] == TAB) |
| break; |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| oldlen += (*mb_ptr2len)(oldp + col + oldlen); |
| #else |
| ++oldlen; |
| #endif |
| /* Deleted a bit too much, insert spaces. */ |
| if (vcol > new_vcol) |
| newlen += vcol - new_vcol; |
| } |
| curwin->w_p_list = old_list; |
| } |
| else |
| #endif |
| if (oldp[col] != NUL) |
| { |
| /* normal replace */ |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| oldlen = (*mb_ptr2len)(oldp + col); |
| #else |
| oldlen = 1; |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Push the replaced bytes onto the replace stack, so that they can be |
| * put back when BS is used. The bytes of a multi-byte character are |
| * done the other way around, so that the first byte is popped off |
| * first (it tells the byte length of the character). */ |
| replace_push(NUL); |
| for (i = 0; i < oldlen; ++i) |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| i += replace_push_mb(oldp + col + i) - 1; |
| else |
| #endif |
| replace_push(oldp[col + i]); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| newp = alloc_check((unsigned)(linelen + newlen - oldlen)); |
| if (newp == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Copy bytes before the cursor. */ |
| if (col > 0) |
| mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col); |
| |
| /* Copy bytes after the changed character(s). */ |
| p = newp + col; |
| mch_memmove(p + newlen, oldp + col + oldlen, |
| (size_t)(linelen - col - oldlen)); |
| |
| /* Insert or overwrite the new character. */ |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| mch_memmove(p, buf, charlen); |
| i = charlen; |
| #else |
| *p = c; |
| i = 1; |
| #endif |
| |
| /* Fill with spaces when necessary. */ |
| while (i < newlen) |
| p[i++] = ' '; |
| |
| /* Replace the line in the buffer. */ |
| ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE); |
| |
| /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */ |
| changed_bytes(lnum, col); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're in Insert or Replace mode and 'showmatch' is set, then briefly |
| * show the match for right parens and braces. |
| */ |
| if (p_sm && (State & INSERT) |
| && msg_silent == 0 |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| && charlen == 1 |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_INS_EXPAND |
| && !ins_compl_active() |
| #endif |
| ) |
| showmatch(c); |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT |
| if (!p_ri || (State & REPLACE_FLAG)) |
| #endif |
| { |
| /* Normal insert: move cursor right */ |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| curwin->w_cursor.col += charlen; |
| #else |
| ++curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| #endif |
| } |
| /* |
| * TODO: should try to update w_row here, to avoid recomputing it later. |
| */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Insert a string at the cursor position. |
| * Note: Does NOT handle Replace mode. |
| * Caller must have prepared for undo. |
| */ |
| void |
| ins_str(s) |
| char_u *s; |
| { |
| char_u *oldp, *newp; |
| int newlen = (int)STRLEN(s); |
| int oldlen; |
| colnr_T col; |
| linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT |
| if (virtual_active() && curwin->w_cursor.coladd > 0) |
| coladvance_force(getviscol()); |
| #endif |
| |
| col = curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| oldp = ml_get(lnum); |
| oldlen = (int)STRLEN(oldp); |
| |
| newp = alloc_check((unsigned)(oldlen + newlen + 1)); |
| if (newp == NULL) |
| return; |
| if (col > 0) |
| mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col); |
| mch_memmove(newp + col, s, (size_t)newlen); |
| mch_memmove(newp + col + newlen, oldp + col, (size_t)(oldlen - col + 1)); |
| ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE); |
| changed_bytes(lnum, col); |
| curwin->w_cursor.col += newlen; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Delete one character under the cursor. |
| * If "fixpos" is TRUE, don't leave the cursor on the NUL after the line. |
| * Caller must have prepared for undo. |
| * |
| * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise |
| */ |
| int |
| del_char(fixpos) |
| int fixpos; |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| { |
| /* Make sure the cursor is at the start of a character. */ |
| mb_adjust_cursor(); |
| if (*ml_get_cursor() == NUL) |
| return FAIL; |
| return del_chars(1L, fixpos); |
| } |
| #endif |
| return del_bytes(1L, fixpos, TRUE); |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Like del_bytes(), but delete characters instead of bytes. |
| */ |
| int |
| del_chars(count, fixpos) |
| long count; |
| int fixpos; |
| { |
| long bytes = 0; |
| long i; |
| char_u *p; |
| int l; |
| |
| p = ml_get_cursor(); |
| for (i = 0; i < count && *p != NUL; ++i) |
| { |
| l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p); |
| bytes += l; |
| p += l; |
| } |
| return del_bytes(bytes, fixpos, TRUE); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Delete "count" bytes under the cursor. |
| * If "fixpos" is TRUE, don't leave the cursor on the NUL after the line. |
| * Caller must have prepared for undo. |
| * |
| * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise |
| */ |
| int |
| del_bytes(count, fixpos_arg, use_delcombine) |
| long count; |
| int fixpos_arg; |
| int use_delcombine UNUSED; /* 'delcombine' option applies */ |
| { |
| char_u *oldp, *newp; |
| colnr_T oldlen; |
| linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| colnr_T col = curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| int was_alloced; |
| long movelen; |
| int fixpos = fixpos_arg; |
| |
| oldp = ml_get(lnum); |
| oldlen = (int)STRLEN(oldp); |
| |
| /* |
| * Can't do anything when the cursor is on the NUL after the line. |
| */ |
| if (col >= oldlen) |
| return FAIL; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| /* If 'delcombine' is set and deleting (less than) one character, only |
| * delete the last combining character. */ |
| if (p_deco && use_delcombine && enc_utf8 |
| && utfc_ptr2len(oldp + col) >= count) |
| { |
| int cc[MAX_MCO]; |
| int n; |
| |
| (void)utfc_ptr2char(oldp + col, cc); |
| if (cc[0] != NUL) |
| { |
| /* Find the last composing char, there can be several. */ |
| n = col; |
| do |
| { |
| col = n; |
| count = utf_ptr2len(oldp + n); |
| n += count; |
| } while (UTF_COMPOSINGLIKE(oldp + col, oldp + n)); |
| fixpos = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * When count is too big, reduce it. |
| */ |
| movelen = (long)oldlen - (long)col - count + 1; /* includes trailing NUL */ |
| if (movelen <= 1) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If we just took off the last character of a non-blank line, and |
| * fixpos is TRUE, we don't want to end up positioned at the NUL, |
| * unless "restart_edit" is set or 'virtualedit' contains "onemore". |
| */ |
| if (col > 0 && fixpos && restart_edit == 0 |
| #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT |
| && (ve_flags & VE_ONEMORE) == 0 |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| --curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT |
| curwin->w_cursor.coladd = 0; |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| curwin->w_cursor.col -= |
| (*mb_head_off)(oldp, oldp + curwin->w_cursor.col); |
| #endif |
| } |
| count = oldlen - col; |
| movelen = 1; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the old line has been allocated the deletion can be done in the |
| * existing line. Otherwise a new line has to be allocated |
| * Can't do this when using Netbeans, because we would need to invoke |
| * netbeans_removed(), which deallocates the line. Let ml_replace() take |
| * care of notifying Netbeans. |
| */ |
| #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG |
| if (netbeans_active()) |
| was_alloced = FALSE; |
| else |
| #endif |
| was_alloced = ml_line_alloced(); /* check if oldp was allocated */ |
| if (was_alloced) |
| newp = oldp; /* use same allocated memory */ |
| else |
| { /* need to allocate a new line */ |
| newp = alloc((unsigned)(oldlen + 1 - count)); |
| if (newp == NULL) |
| return FAIL; |
| mch_memmove(newp, oldp, (size_t)col); |
| } |
| mch_memmove(newp + col, oldp + col + count, (size_t)movelen); |
| if (!was_alloced) |
| ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE); |
| |
| /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */ |
| changed_bytes(lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col); |
| |
| return OK; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Delete from cursor to end of line. |
| * Caller must have prepared for undo. |
| * |
| * return FAIL for failure, OK otherwise |
| */ |
| int |
| truncate_line(fixpos) |
| int fixpos; /* if TRUE fix the cursor position when done */ |
| { |
| char_u *newp; |
| linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| colnr_T col = curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| |
| if (col == 0) |
| newp = vim_strsave((char_u *)""); |
| else |
| newp = vim_strnsave(ml_get(lnum), col); |
| |
| if (newp == NULL) |
| return FAIL; |
| |
| ml_replace(lnum, newp, FALSE); |
| |
| /* mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */ |
| changed_bytes(lnum, curwin->w_cursor.col); |
| |
| /* |
| * If "fixpos" is TRUE we don't want to end up positioned at the NUL. |
| */ |
| if (fixpos && curwin->w_cursor.col > 0) |
| --curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| |
| return OK; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Delete "nlines" lines at the cursor. |
| * Saves the lines for undo first if "undo" is TRUE. |
| */ |
| void |
| del_lines(nlines, undo) |
| long nlines; /* number of lines to delete */ |
| int undo; /* if TRUE, prepare for undo */ |
| { |
| long n; |
| linenr_T first = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| |
| if (nlines <= 0) |
| return; |
| |
| /* save the deleted lines for undo */ |
| if (undo && u_savedel(first, nlines) == FAIL) |
| return; |
| |
| for (n = 0; n < nlines; ) |
| { |
| if (curbuf->b_ml.ml_flags & ML_EMPTY) /* nothing to delete */ |
| break; |
| |
| ml_delete(first, TRUE); |
| ++n; |
| |
| /* If we delete the last line in the file, stop */ |
| if (first > curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* Correct the cursor position before calling deleted_lines_mark(), it may |
| * trigger a callback to display the cursor. */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| check_cursor_lnum(); |
| |
| /* adjust marks, mark the buffer as changed and prepare for displaying */ |
| deleted_lines_mark(first, n); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| gchar_pos(pos) |
| pos_T *pos; |
| { |
| char_u *ptr = ml_get_pos(pos); |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| return (*mb_ptr2char)(ptr); |
| #endif |
| return (int)*ptr; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| gchar_cursor() |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| return (*mb_ptr2char)(ml_get_cursor()); |
| #endif |
| return (int)*ml_get_cursor(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write a character at the current cursor position. |
| * It is directly written into the block. |
| */ |
| void |
| pchar_cursor(c) |
| int c; |
| { |
| *(ml_get_buf(curbuf, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, TRUE) |
| + curwin->w_cursor.col) = c; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * When extra == 0: Return TRUE if the cursor is before or on the first |
| * non-blank in the line. |
| * When extra == 1: Return TRUE if the cursor is before the first non-blank in |
| * the line. |
| */ |
| int |
| inindent(extra) |
| int extra; |
| { |
| char_u *ptr; |
| colnr_T col; |
| |
| for (col = 0, ptr = ml_get_curline(); vim_iswhite(*ptr); ++col) |
| ++ptr; |
| if (col >= curwin->w_cursor.col + extra) |
| return TRUE; |
| else |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Skip to next part of an option argument: Skip space and comma. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| skip_to_option_part(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| if (*p == ',') |
| ++p; |
| while (*p == ' ') |
| ++p; |
| return p; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Call this function when something in the current buffer is changed. |
| * |
| * Most often called through changed_bytes() and changed_lines(), which also |
| * mark the area of the display to be redrawn. |
| * |
| * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. |
| */ |
| void |
| changed() |
| { |
| #if defined(FEAT_XIM) && defined(FEAT_GUI_GTK) |
| /* The text of the preediting area is inserted, but this doesn't |
| * mean a change of the buffer yet. That is delayed until the |
| * text is committed. (this means preedit becomes empty) */ |
| if (im_is_preediting() && !xim_changed_while_preediting) |
| return; |
| xim_changed_while_preediting = FALSE; |
| #endif |
| |
| if (!curbuf->b_changed) |
| { |
| int save_msg_scroll = msg_scroll; |
| |
| /* Give a warning about changing a read-only file. This may also |
| * check-out the file, thus change "curbuf"! */ |
| change_warning(0); |
| |
| /* Create a swap file if that is wanted. |
| * Don't do this for "nofile" and "nowrite" buffer types. */ |
| if (curbuf->b_may_swap |
| #ifdef FEAT_QUICKFIX |
| && !bt_dontwrite(curbuf) |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| ml_open_file(curbuf); |
| |
| /* The ml_open_file() can cause an ATTENTION message. |
| * Wait two seconds, to make sure the user reads this unexpected |
| * message. Since we could be anywhere, call wait_return() now, |
| * and don't let the emsg() set msg_scroll. */ |
| if (need_wait_return && emsg_silent == 0) |
| { |
| out_flush(); |
| ui_delay(2000L, TRUE); |
| wait_return(TRUE); |
| msg_scroll = save_msg_scroll; |
| } |
| } |
| changed_int(); |
| } |
| ++curbuf->b_changedtick; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Internal part of changed(), no user interaction. |
| */ |
| void |
| changed_int() |
| { |
| curbuf->b_changed = TRUE; |
| ml_setflags(curbuf); |
| #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS |
| check_status(curbuf); |
| redraw_tabline = TRUE; |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_TITLE |
| need_maketitle = TRUE; /* set window title later */ |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| static void changedOneline __ARGS((buf_T *buf, linenr_T lnum)); |
| static void changed_lines_buf __ARGS((buf_T *buf, linenr_T lnum, linenr_T lnume, long xtra)); |
| static void changed_common __ARGS((linenr_T lnum, colnr_T col, linenr_T lnume, long xtra)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Changed bytes within a single line for the current buffer. |
| * - marks the windows on this buffer to be redisplayed |
| * - marks the buffer changed by calling changed() |
| * - invalidates cached values |
| * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. |
| */ |
| void |
| changed_bytes(lnum, col) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| colnr_T col; |
| { |
| changedOneline(curbuf, lnum); |
| changed_common(lnum, col, lnum + 1, 0L); |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_DIFF |
| /* Diff highlighting in other diff windows may need to be updated too. */ |
| if (curwin->w_p_diff) |
| { |
| win_T *wp; |
| linenr_T wlnum; |
| |
| for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next) |
| if (wp->w_p_diff && wp != curwin) |
| { |
| redraw_win_later(wp, VALID); |
| wlnum = diff_lnum_win(lnum, wp); |
| if (wlnum > 0) |
| changedOneline(wp->w_buffer, wlnum); |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| changedOneline(buf, lnum) |
| buf_T *buf; |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| if (buf->b_mod_set) |
| { |
| /* find the maximum area that must be redisplayed */ |
| if (lnum < buf->b_mod_top) |
| buf->b_mod_top = lnum; |
| else if (lnum >= buf->b_mod_bot) |
| buf->b_mod_bot = lnum + 1; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* set the area that must be redisplayed to one line */ |
| buf->b_mod_set = TRUE; |
| buf->b_mod_top = lnum; |
| buf->b_mod_bot = lnum + 1; |
| buf->b_mod_xlines = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Appended "count" lines below line "lnum" in the current buffer. |
| * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust(). |
| * Takes care of marking the buffer to be redrawn and sets the changed flag. |
| */ |
| void |
| appended_lines(lnum, count) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| long count; |
| { |
| changed_lines(lnum + 1, 0, lnum + 1, count); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Like appended_lines(), but adjust marks first. |
| */ |
| void |
| appended_lines_mark(lnum, count) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| long count; |
| { |
| mark_adjust(lnum + 1, (linenr_T)MAXLNUM, count, 0L); |
| changed_lines(lnum + 1, 0, lnum + 1, count); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Deleted "count" lines at line "lnum" in the current buffer. |
| * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust(). |
| * Takes care of marking the buffer to be redrawn and sets the changed flag. |
| */ |
| void |
| deleted_lines(lnum, count) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| long count; |
| { |
| changed_lines(lnum, 0, lnum + count, -count); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Like deleted_lines(), but adjust marks first. |
| * Make sure the cursor is on a valid line before calling, a GUI callback may |
| * be triggered to display the cursor. |
| */ |
| void |
| deleted_lines_mark(lnum, count) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| long count; |
| { |
| mark_adjust(lnum, (linenr_T)(lnum + count - 1), (long)MAXLNUM, -count); |
| changed_lines(lnum, 0, lnum + count, -count); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Changed lines for the current buffer. |
| * Must be called AFTER the change and after mark_adjust(). |
| * - mark the buffer changed by calling changed() |
| * - mark the windows on this buffer to be redisplayed |
| * - invalidate cached values |
| * "lnum" is the first line that needs displaying, "lnume" the first line |
| * below the changed lines (BEFORE the change). |
| * When only inserting lines, "lnum" and "lnume" are equal. |
| * Takes care of calling changed() and updating b_mod_*. |
| * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. |
| */ |
| void |
| changed_lines(lnum, col, lnume, xtra) |
| linenr_T lnum; /* first line with change */ |
| colnr_T col; /* column in first line with change */ |
| linenr_T lnume; /* line below last changed line */ |
| long xtra; /* number of extra lines (negative when deleting) */ |
| { |
| changed_lines_buf(curbuf, lnum, lnume, xtra); |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_DIFF |
| if (xtra == 0 && curwin->w_p_diff) |
| { |
| /* When the number of lines doesn't change then mark_adjust() isn't |
| * called and other diff buffers still need to be marked for |
| * displaying. */ |
| win_T *wp; |
| linenr_T wlnum; |
| |
| for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next) |
| if (wp->w_p_diff && wp != curwin) |
| { |
| redraw_win_later(wp, VALID); |
| wlnum = diff_lnum_win(lnum, wp); |
| if (wlnum > 0) |
| changed_lines_buf(wp->w_buffer, wlnum, |
| lnume - lnum + wlnum, 0L); |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| changed_common(lnum, col, lnume, xtra); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| changed_lines_buf(buf, lnum, lnume, xtra) |
| buf_T *buf; |
| linenr_T lnum; /* first line with change */ |
| linenr_T lnume; /* line below last changed line */ |
| long xtra; /* number of extra lines (negative when deleting) */ |
| { |
| if (buf->b_mod_set) |
| { |
| /* find the maximum area that must be redisplayed */ |
| if (lnum < buf->b_mod_top) |
| buf->b_mod_top = lnum; |
| if (lnum < buf->b_mod_bot) |
| { |
| /* adjust old bot position for xtra lines */ |
| buf->b_mod_bot += xtra; |
| if (buf->b_mod_bot < lnum) |
| buf->b_mod_bot = lnum; |
| } |
| if (lnume + xtra > buf->b_mod_bot) |
| buf->b_mod_bot = lnume + xtra; |
| buf->b_mod_xlines += xtra; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* set the area that must be redisplayed */ |
| buf->b_mod_set = TRUE; |
| buf->b_mod_top = lnum; |
| buf->b_mod_bot = lnume + xtra; |
| buf->b_mod_xlines = xtra; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Common code for when a change is was made. |
| * See changed_lines() for the arguments. |
| * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. |
| */ |
| static void |
| changed_common(lnum, col, lnume, xtra) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| colnr_T col; |
| linenr_T lnume; |
| long xtra; |
| { |
| win_T *wp; |
| #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS |
| tabpage_T *tp; |
| #endif |
| int i; |
| #ifdef FEAT_JUMPLIST |
| int cols; |
| pos_T *p; |
| int add; |
| #endif |
| |
| /* mark the buffer as modified */ |
| changed(); |
| |
| /* set the '. mark */ |
| if (!cmdmod.keepjumps) |
| { |
| curbuf->b_last_change.lnum = lnum; |
| curbuf->b_last_change.col = col; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_JUMPLIST |
| /* Create a new entry if a new undo-able change was started or we |
| * don't have an entry yet. */ |
| if (curbuf->b_new_change || curbuf->b_changelistlen == 0) |
| { |
| if (curbuf->b_changelistlen == 0) |
| add = TRUE; |
| else |
| { |
| /* Don't create a new entry when the line number is the same |
| * as the last one and the column is not too far away. Avoids |
| * creating many entries for typing "xxxxx". */ |
| p = &curbuf->b_changelist[curbuf->b_changelistlen - 1]; |
| if (p->lnum != lnum) |
| add = TRUE; |
| else |
| { |
| cols = comp_textwidth(FALSE); |
| if (cols == 0) |
| cols = 79; |
| add = (p->col + cols < col || col + cols < p->col); |
| } |
| } |
| if (add) |
| { |
| /* This is the first of a new sequence of undo-able changes |
| * and it's at some distance of the last change. Use a new |
| * position in the changelist. */ |
| curbuf->b_new_change = FALSE; |
| |
| if (curbuf->b_changelistlen == JUMPLISTSIZE) |
| { |
| /* changelist is full: remove oldest entry */ |
| curbuf->b_changelistlen = JUMPLISTSIZE - 1; |
| mch_memmove(curbuf->b_changelist, curbuf->b_changelist + 1, |
| sizeof(pos_T) * (JUMPLISTSIZE - 1)); |
| FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp) |
| { |
| /* Correct position in changelist for other windows on |
| * this buffer. */ |
| if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf && wp->w_changelistidx > 0) |
| --wp->w_changelistidx; |
| } |
| } |
| FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp) |
| { |
| /* For other windows, if the position in the changelist is |
| * at the end it stays at the end. */ |
| if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf |
| && wp->w_changelistidx == curbuf->b_changelistlen) |
| ++wp->w_changelistidx; |
| } |
| ++curbuf->b_changelistlen; |
| } |
| } |
| curbuf->b_changelist[curbuf->b_changelistlen - 1] = |
| curbuf->b_last_change; |
| /* The current window is always after the last change, so that "g," |
| * takes you back to it. */ |
| curwin->w_changelistidx = curbuf->b_changelistlen; |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| FOR_ALL_TAB_WINDOWS(tp, wp) |
| { |
| if (wp->w_buffer == curbuf) |
| { |
| /* Mark this window to be redrawn later. */ |
| if (wp->w_redr_type < VALID) |
| wp->w_redr_type = VALID; |
| |
| /* Check if a change in the buffer has invalidated the cached |
| * values for the cursor. */ |
| #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING |
| /* |
| * Update the folds for this window. Can't postpone this, because |
| * a following operator might work on the whole fold: ">>dd". |
| */ |
| foldUpdate(wp, lnum, lnume + xtra - 1); |
| |
| /* The change may cause lines above or below the change to become |
| * included in a fold. Set lnum/lnume to the first/last line that |
| * might be displayed differently. |
| * Set w_cline_folded here as an efficient way to update it when |
| * inserting lines just above a closed fold. */ |
| i = hasFoldingWin(wp, lnum, &lnum, NULL, FALSE, NULL); |
| if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnum) |
| wp->w_cline_folded = i; |
| i = hasFoldingWin(wp, lnume, NULL, &lnume, FALSE, NULL); |
| if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnume) |
| wp->w_cline_folded = i; |
| |
| /* If the changed line is in a range of previously folded lines, |
| * compare with the first line in that range. */ |
| if (wp->w_cursor.lnum <= lnum) |
| { |
| i = find_wl_entry(wp, lnum); |
| if (i >= 0 && wp->w_cursor.lnum > wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum) |
| changed_line_abv_curs_win(wp); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| if (wp->w_cursor.lnum > lnum) |
| changed_line_abv_curs_win(wp); |
| else if (wp->w_cursor.lnum == lnum && wp->w_cursor.col >= col) |
| changed_cline_bef_curs_win(wp); |
| if (wp->w_botline >= lnum) |
| { |
| /* Assume that botline doesn't change (inserted lines make |
| * other lines scroll down below botline). */ |
| approximate_botline_win(wp); |
| } |
| |
| /* Check if any w_lines[] entries have become invalid. |
| * For entries below the change: Correct the lnums for |
| * inserted/deleted lines. Makes it possible to stop displaying |
| * after the change. */ |
| for (i = 0; i < wp->w_lines_valid; ++i) |
| if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid) |
| { |
| if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum >= lnum) |
| { |
| if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum < lnume) |
| { |
| /* line included in change */ |
| wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid = FALSE; |
| } |
| else if (xtra != 0) |
| { |
| /* line below change */ |
| wp->w_lines[i].wl_lnum += xtra; |
| #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING |
| wp->w_lines[i].wl_lastlnum += xtra; |
| #endif |
| } |
| } |
| #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING |
| else if (wp->w_lines[i].wl_lastlnum >= lnum) |
| { |
| /* change somewhere inside this range of folded lines, |
| * may need to be redrawn */ |
| wp->w_lines[i].wl_valid = FALSE; |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING |
| /* Take care of side effects for setting w_topline when folds have |
| * changed. Esp. when the buffer was changed in another window. */ |
| if (hasAnyFolding(wp)) |
| set_topline(wp, wp->w_topline); |
| #endif |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Call update_screen() later, which checks out what needs to be redrawn, |
| * since it notices b_mod_set and then uses b_mod_*. */ |
| if (must_redraw < VALID) |
| must_redraw = VALID; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD |
| /* when the cursor line is changed always trigger CursorMoved */ |
| if (lnum <= curwin->w_cursor.lnum |
| && lnume + (xtra < 0 ? -xtra : xtra) > curwin->w_cursor.lnum) |
| last_cursormoved.lnum = 0; |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * unchanged() is called when the changed flag must be reset for buffer 'buf' |
| */ |
| void |
| unchanged(buf, ff) |
| buf_T *buf; |
| int ff; /* also reset 'fileformat' */ |
| { |
| if (buf->b_changed || (ff && file_ff_differs(buf, FALSE))) |
| { |
| buf->b_changed = 0; |
| ml_setflags(buf); |
| if (ff) |
| save_file_ff(buf); |
| #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS |
| check_status(buf); |
| redraw_tabline = TRUE; |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_TITLE |
| need_maketitle = TRUE; /* set window title later */ |
| #endif |
| } |
| ++buf->b_changedtick; |
| #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG |
| netbeans_unmodified(buf); |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_WINDOWS) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * check_status: called when the status bars for the buffer 'buf' |
| * need to be updated |
| */ |
| void |
| check_status(buf) |
| buf_T *buf; |
| { |
| win_T *wp; |
| |
| for (wp = firstwin; wp != NULL; wp = wp->w_next) |
| if (wp->w_buffer == buf && wp->w_status_height) |
| { |
| wp->w_redr_status = TRUE; |
| if (must_redraw < VALID) |
| must_redraw = VALID; |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * If the file is readonly, give a warning message with the first change. |
| * Don't do this for autocommands. |
| * Don't use emsg(), because it flushes the macro buffer. |
| * If we have undone all changes b_changed will be FALSE, but "b_did_warn" |
| * will be TRUE. |
| * Careful: may trigger autocommands that reload the buffer. |
| */ |
| void |
| change_warning(col) |
| int col; /* column for message; non-zero when in insert |
| mode and 'showmode' is on */ |
| { |
| static char *w_readonly = N_("W10: Warning: Changing a readonly file"); |
| |
| if (curbuf->b_did_warn == FALSE |
| && curbufIsChanged() == 0 |
| #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD |
| && !autocmd_busy |
| #endif |
| && curbuf->b_p_ro) |
| { |
| #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD |
| ++curbuf_lock; |
| apply_autocmds(EVENT_FILECHANGEDRO, NULL, NULL, FALSE, curbuf); |
| --curbuf_lock; |
| if (!curbuf->b_p_ro) |
| return; |
| #endif |
| /* |
| * Do what msg() does, but with a column offset if the warning should |
| * be after the mode message. |
| */ |
| msg_start(); |
| if (msg_row == Rows - 1) |
| msg_col = col; |
| msg_source(hl_attr(HLF_W)); |
| MSG_PUTS_ATTR(_(w_readonly), hl_attr(HLF_W) | MSG_HIST); |
| #ifdef FEAT_EVAL |
| set_vim_var_string(VV_WARNINGMSG, (char_u *)_(w_readonly), -1); |
| #endif |
| msg_clr_eos(); |
| (void)msg_end(); |
| if (msg_silent == 0 && !silent_mode) |
| { |
| out_flush(); |
| ui_delay(1000L, TRUE); /* give the user time to think about it */ |
| } |
| curbuf->b_did_warn = TRUE; |
| redraw_cmdline = FALSE; /* don't redraw and erase the message */ |
| if (msg_row < Rows - 1) |
| showmode(); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Ask for a reply from the user, a 'y' or a 'n'. |
| * No other characters are accepted, the message is repeated until a valid |
| * reply is entered or CTRL-C is hit. |
| * If direct is TRUE, don't use vgetc() but ui_inchar(), don't get characters |
| * from any buffers but directly from the user. |
| * |
| * return the 'y' or 'n' |
| */ |
| int |
| ask_yesno(str, direct) |
| char_u *str; |
| int direct; |
| { |
| int r = ' '; |
| int save_State = State; |
| |
| if (exiting) /* put terminal in raw mode for this question */ |
| settmode(TMODE_RAW); |
| ++no_wait_return; |
| #ifdef USE_ON_FLY_SCROLL |
| dont_scroll = TRUE; /* disallow scrolling here */ |
| #endif |
| State = CONFIRM; /* mouse behaves like with :confirm */ |
| #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE |
| setmouse(); /* disables mouse for xterm */ |
| #endif |
| ++no_mapping; |
| ++allow_keys; /* no mapping here, but recognize keys */ |
| |
| while (r != 'y' && r != 'n') |
| { |
| /* same highlighting as for wait_return */ |
| smsg_attr(hl_attr(HLF_R), (char_u *)"%s (y/n)?", str); |
| if (direct) |
| r = get_keystroke(); |
| else |
| r = plain_vgetc(); |
| if (r == Ctrl_C || r == ESC) |
| r = 'n'; |
| msg_putchar(r); /* show what you typed */ |
| out_flush(); |
| } |
| --no_wait_return; |
| State = save_State; |
| #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE |
| setmouse(); |
| #endif |
| --no_mapping; |
| --allow_keys; |
| |
| return r; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get a key stroke directly from the user. |
| * Ignores mouse clicks and scrollbar events, except a click for the left |
| * button (used at the more prompt). |
| * Doesn't use vgetc(), because it syncs undo and eats mapped characters. |
| * Disadvantage: typeahead is ignored. |
| * Translates the interrupt character for unix to ESC. |
| */ |
| int |
| get_keystroke() |
| { |
| char_u *buf = NULL; |
| int buflen = 150; |
| int maxlen; |
| int len = 0; |
| int n; |
| int save_mapped_ctrl_c = mapped_ctrl_c; |
| int waited = 0; |
| |
| mapped_ctrl_c = FALSE; /* mappings are not used here */ |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| cursor_on(); |
| out_flush(); |
| |
| /* Leave some room for check_termcode() to insert a key code into (max |
| * 5 chars plus NUL). And fix_input_buffer() can triple the number of |
| * bytes. */ |
| maxlen = (buflen - 6 - len) / 3; |
| if (buf == NULL) |
| buf = alloc(buflen); |
| else if (maxlen < 10) |
| { |
| /* Need some more space. This might happen when receiving a long |
| * escape sequence. */ |
| buflen += 100; |
| buf = vim_realloc(buf, buflen); |
| maxlen = (buflen - 6 - len) / 3; |
| } |
| if (buf == NULL) |
| { |
| do_outofmem_msg((long_u)buflen); |
| return ESC; /* panic! */ |
| } |
| |
| /* First time: blocking wait. Second time: wait up to 100ms for a |
| * terminal code to complete. */ |
| n = ui_inchar(buf + len, maxlen, len == 0 ? -1L : 100L, 0); |
| if (n > 0) |
| { |
| /* Replace zero and CSI by a special key code. */ |
| n = fix_input_buffer(buf + len, n, FALSE); |
| len += n; |
| waited = 0; |
| } |
| else if (len > 0) |
| ++waited; /* keep track of the waiting time */ |
| |
| /* Incomplete termcode and not timed out yet: get more characters */ |
| if ((n = check_termcode(1, buf, buflen, &len)) < 0 |
| && (!p_ttimeout || waited * 100L < (p_ttm < 0 ? p_tm : p_ttm))) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (n == KEYLEN_REMOVED) /* key code removed */ |
| { |
| if (must_redraw != 0 && !need_wait_return && (State & CMDLINE) == 0) |
| { |
| /* Redrawing was postponed, do it now. */ |
| update_screen(0); |
| setcursor(); /* put cursor back where it belongs */ |
| } |
| continue; |
| } |
| if (n > 0) /* found a termcode: adjust length */ |
| len = n; |
| if (len == 0) /* nothing typed yet */ |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Handle modifier and/or special key code. */ |
| n = buf[0]; |
| if (n == K_SPECIAL) |
| { |
| n = TO_SPECIAL(buf[1], buf[2]); |
| if (buf[1] == KS_MODIFIER |
| || n == K_IGNORE |
| #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE |
| || n == K_LEFTMOUSE_NM |
| || n == K_LEFTDRAG |
| || n == K_LEFTRELEASE |
| || n == K_LEFTRELEASE_NM |
| || n == K_MIDDLEMOUSE |
| || n == K_MIDDLEDRAG |
| || n == K_MIDDLERELEASE |
| || n == K_RIGHTMOUSE |
| || n == K_RIGHTDRAG |
| || n == K_RIGHTRELEASE |
| || n == K_MOUSEDOWN |
| || n == K_MOUSEUP |
| || n == K_MOUSELEFT |
| || n == K_MOUSERIGHT |
| || n == K_X1MOUSE |
| || n == K_X1DRAG |
| || n == K_X1RELEASE |
| || n == K_X2MOUSE |
| || n == K_X2DRAG |
| || n == K_X2RELEASE |
| # ifdef FEAT_GUI |
| || n == K_VER_SCROLLBAR |
| || n == K_HOR_SCROLLBAR |
| # endif |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| if (buf[1] == KS_MODIFIER) |
| mod_mask = buf[2]; |
| len -= 3; |
| if (len > 0) |
| mch_memmove(buf, buf + 3, (size_t)len); |
| continue; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| { |
| if (MB_BYTE2LEN(n) > len) |
| continue; /* more bytes to get */ |
| buf[len >= buflen ? buflen - 1 : len] = NUL; |
| n = (*mb_ptr2char)(buf); |
| } |
| #endif |
| #ifdef UNIX |
| if (n == intr_char) |
| n = ESC; |
| #endif |
| break; |
| } |
| vim_free(buf); |
| |
| mapped_ctrl_c = save_mapped_ctrl_c; |
| return n; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get a number from the user. |
| * When "mouse_used" is not NULL allow using the mouse. |
| */ |
| int |
| get_number(colon, mouse_used) |
| int colon; /* allow colon to abort */ |
| int *mouse_used; |
| { |
| int n = 0; |
| int c; |
| int typed = 0; |
| |
| if (mouse_used != NULL) |
| *mouse_used = FALSE; |
| |
| /* When not printing messages, the user won't know what to type, return a |
| * zero (as if CR was hit). */ |
| if (msg_silent != 0) |
| return 0; |
| |
| #ifdef USE_ON_FLY_SCROLL |
| dont_scroll = TRUE; /* disallow scrolling here */ |
| #endif |
| ++no_mapping; |
| ++allow_keys; /* no mapping here, but recognize keys */ |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| windgoto(msg_row, msg_col); |
| c = safe_vgetc(); |
| if (VIM_ISDIGIT(c)) |
| { |
| n = n * 10 + c - '0'; |
| msg_putchar(c); |
| ++typed; |
| } |
| else if (c == K_DEL || c == K_KDEL || c == K_BS || c == Ctrl_H) |
| { |
| if (typed > 0) |
| { |
| MSG_PUTS("\b \b"); |
| --typed; |
| } |
| n /= 10; |
| } |
| #ifdef FEAT_MOUSE |
| else if (mouse_used != NULL && c == K_LEFTMOUSE) |
| { |
| *mouse_used = TRUE; |
| n = mouse_row + 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| #endif |
| else if (n == 0 && c == ':' && colon) |
| { |
| stuffcharReadbuff(':'); |
| if (!exmode_active) |
| cmdline_row = msg_row; |
| skip_redraw = TRUE; /* skip redraw once */ |
| do_redraw = FALSE; |
| break; |
| } |
| else if (c == CAR || c == NL || c == Ctrl_C || c == ESC) |
| break; |
| } |
| --no_mapping; |
| --allow_keys; |
| return n; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Ask the user to enter a number. |
| * When "mouse_used" is not NULL allow using the mouse and in that case return |
| * the line number. |
| */ |
| int |
| prompt_for_number(mouse_used) |
| int *mouse_used; |
| { |
| int i; |
| int save_cmdline_row; |
| int save_State; |
| |
| /* When using ":silent" assume that <CR> was entered. */ |
| if (mouse_used != NULL) |
| MSG_PUTS(_("Type number and <Enter> or click with mouse (empty cancels): ")); |
| else |
| MSG_PUTS(_("Type number and <Enter> (empty cancels): ")); |
| |
| /* Set the state such that text can be selected/copied/pasted and we still |
| * get mouse events. */ |
| save_cmdline_row = cmdline_row; |
| cmdline_row = 0; |
| save_State = State; |
| State = CMDLINE; |
| |
| i = get_number(TRUE, mouse_used); |
| if (KeyTyped) |
| { |
| /* don't call wait_return() now */ |
| /* msg_putchar('\n'); */ |
| cmdline_row = msg_row - 1; |
| need_wait_return = FALSE; |
| msg_didany = FALSE; |
| msg_didout = FALSE; |
| } |
| else |
| cmdline_row = save_cmdline_row; |
| State = save_State; |
| |
| return i; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| msgmore(n) |
| long n; |
| { |
| long pn; |
| |
| if (global_busy /* no messages now, wait until global is finished */ |
| || !messaging()) /* 'lazyredraw' set, don't do messages now */ |
| return; |
| |
| /* We don't want to overwrite another important message, but do overwrite |
| * a previous "more lines" or "fewer lines" message, so that "5dd" and |
| * then "put" reports the last action. */ |
| if (keep_msg != NULL && !keep_msg_more) |
| return; |
| |
| if (n > 0) |
| pn = n; |
| else |
| pn = -n; |
| |
| if (pn > p_report) |
| { |
| if (pn == 1) |
| { |
| if (n > 0) |
| vim_strncpy(msg_buf, (char_u *)_("1 more line"), |
| MSG_BUF_LEN - 1); |
| else |
| vim_strncpy(msg_buf, (char_u *)_("1 line less"), |
| MSG_BUF_LEN - 1); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (n > 0) |
| vim_snprintf((char *)msg_buf, MSG_BUF_LEN, |
| _("%ld more lines"), pn); |
| else |
| vim_snprintf((char *)msg_buf, MSG_BUF_LEN, |
| _("%ld fewer lines"), pn); |
| } |
| if (got_int) |
| vim_strcat(msg_buf, (char_u *)_(" (Interrupted)"), MSG_BUF_LEN); |
| if (msg(msg_buf)) |
| { |
| set_keep_msg(msg_buf, 0); |
| keep_msg_more = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * flush map and typeahead buffers and give a warning for an error |
| */ |
| void |
| beep_flush() |
| { |
| if (emsg_silent == 0) |
| { |
| flush_buffers(FALSE); |
| vim_beep(); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * give a warning for an error |
| */ |
| void |
| vim_beep() |
| { |
| if (emsg_silent == 0) |
| { |
| if (p_vb |
| #ifdef FEAT_GUI |
| /* While the GUI is starting up the termcap is set for the GUI |
| * but the output still goes to a terminal. */ |
| && !(gui.in_use && gui.starting) |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| out_str(T_VB); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| #ifdef MSDOS |
| /* |
| * The number of beeps outputted is reduced to avoid having to wait |
| * for all the beeps to finish. This is only a problem on systems |
| * where the beeps don't overlap. |
| */ |
| if (beep_count == 0 || beep_count == 10) |
| { |
| out_char(BELL); |
| beep_count = 1; |
| } |
| else |
| ++beep_count; |
| #else |
| out_char(BELL); |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| /* When 'verbose' is set and we are sourcing a script or executing a |
| * function give the user a hint where the beep comes from. */ |
| if (vim_strchr(p_debug, 'e') != NULL) |
| { |
| msg_source(hl_attr(HLF_W)); |
| msg_attr((char_u *)_("Beep!"), hl_attr(HLF_W)); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * To get the "real" home directory: |
| * - get value of $HOME |
| * For Unix: |
| * - go to that directory |
| * - do mch_dirname() to get the real name of that directory. |
| * This also works with mounts and links. |
| * Don't do this for MS-DOS, it will change the "current dir" for a drive. |
| */ |
| static char_u *homedir = NULL; |
| |
| void |
| init_homedir() |
| { |
| char_u *var; |
| |
| /* In case we are called a second time (when 'encoding' changes). */ |
| vim_free(homedir); |
| homedir = NULL; |
| |
| #ifdef VMS |
| var = mch_getenv((char_u *)"SYS$LOGIN"); |
| #else |
| var = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOME"); |
| #endif |
| |
| if (var != NULL && *var == NUL) /* empty is same as not set */ |
| var = NULL; |
| |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| /* |
| * Weird but true: $HOME may contain an indirect reference to another |
| * variable, esp. "%USERPROFILE%". Happens when $USERPROFILE isn't set |
| * when $HOME is being set. |
| */ |
| if (var != NULL && *var == '%') |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| char_u *exp; |
| |
| p = vim_strchr(var + 1, '%'); |
| if (p != NULL) |
| { |
| vim_strncpy(NameBuff, var + 1, p - (var + 1)); |
| exp = mch_getenv(NameBuff); |
| if (exp != NULL && *exp != NUL |
| && STRLEN(exp) + STRLEN(p) < MAXPATHL) |
| { |
| vim_snprintf((char *)NameBuff, MAXPATHL, "%s%s", exp, p + 1); |
| var = NameBuff; |
| /* Also set $HOME, it's needed for _viminfo. */ |
| vim_setenv((char_u *)"HOME", NameBuff); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Typically, $HOME is not defined on Windows, unless the user has |
| * specifically defined it for Vim's sake. However, on Windows NT |
| * platforms, $HOMEDRIVE and $HOMEPATH are automatically defined for |
| * each user. Try constructing $HOME from these. |
| */ |
| if (var == NULL) |
| { |
| char_u *homedrive, *homepath; |
| |
| homedrive = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOMEDRIVE"); |
| homepath = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOMEPATH"); |
| if (homepath == NULL || *homepath == NUL) |
| homepath = "\\"; |
| if (homedrive != NULL |
| && STRLEN(homedrive) + STRLEN(homepath) < MAXPATHL) |
| { |
| sprintf((char *)NameBuff, "%s%s", homedrive, homepath); |
| if (NameBuff[0] != NUL) |
| { |
| var = NameBuff; |
| /* Also set $HOME, it's needed for _viminfo. */ |
| vim_setenv((char_u *)"HOME", NameBuff); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| # if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) |
| if (enc_utf8 && var != NULL) |
| { |
| int len; |
| char_u *pp = NULL; |
| |
| /* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8. Other conversions are |
| * not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII characters. */ |
| acp_to_enc(var, (int)STRLEN(var), &pp, &len); |
| if (pp != NULL) |
| { |
| homedir = pp; |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| # endif |
| #endif |
| |
| #if defined(OS2) || defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) |
| /* |
| * Default home dir is C:/ |
| * Best assumption we can make in such a situation. |
| */ |
| if (var == NULL) |
| var = "C:/"; |
| #endif |
| if (var != NULL) |
| { |
| #ifdef UNIX |
| /* |
| * Change to the directory and get the actual path. This resolves |
| * links. Don't do it when we can't return. |
| */ |
| if (mch_dirname(NameBuff, MAXPATHL) == OK |
| && mch_chdir((char *)NameBuff) == 0) |
| { |
| if (!mch_chdir((char *)var) && mch_dirname(IObuff, IOSIZE) == OK) |
| var = IObuff; |
| if (mch_chdir((char *)NameBuff) != 0) |
| EMSG(_(e_prev_dir)); |
| } |
| #endif |
| homedir = vim_strsave(var); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(EXITFREE) || defined(PROTO) |
| void |
| free_homedir() |
| { |
| vim_free(homedir); |
| } |
| |
| # ifdef FEAT_CMDL_COMPL |
| void |
| free_users() |
| { |
| ga_clear_strings(&ga_users); |
| } |
| # endif |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Call expand_env() and store the result in an allocated string. |
| * This is not very memory efficient, this expects the result to be freed |
| * again soon. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| expand_env_save(src) |
| char_u *src; |
| { |
| return expand_env_save_opt(src, FALSE); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Idem, but when "one" is TRUE handle the string as one file name, only |
| * expand "~" at the start. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| expand_env_save_opt(src, one) |
| char_u *src; |
| int one; |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| |
| p = alloc(MAXPATHL); |
| if (p != NULL) |
| expand_env_esc(src, p, MAXPATHL, FALSE, one, NULL); |
| return p; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Expand environment variable with path name. |
| * "~/" is also expanded, using $HOME. For Unix "~user/" is expanded. |
| * Skips over "\ ", "\~" and "\$" (not for Win32 though). |
| * If anything fails no expansion is done and dst equals src. |
| */ |
| void |
| expand_env(src, dst, dstlen) |
| char_u *src; /* input string e.g. "$HOME/vim.hlp" */ |
| char_u *dst; /* where to put the result */ |
| int dstlen; /* maximum length of the result */ |
| { |
| expand_env_esc(src, dst, dstlen, FALSE, FALSE, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| expand_env_esc(srcp, dst, dstlen, esc, one, startstr) |
| char_u *srcp; /* input string e.g. "$HOME/vim.hlp" */ |
| char_u *dst; /* where to put the result */ |
| int dstlen; /* maximum length of the result */ |
| int esc; /* escape spaces in expanded variables */ |
| int one; /* "srcp" is one file name */ |
| char_u *startstr; /* start again after this (can be NULL) */ |
| { |
| char_u *src; |
| char_u *tail; |
| int c; |
| char_u *var; |
| int copy_char; |
| int mustfree; /* var was allocated, need to free it later */ |
| int at_start = TRUE; /* at start of a name */ |
| int startstr_len = 0; |
| |
| if (startstr != NULL) |
| startstr_len = (int)STRLEN(startstr); |
| |
| src = skipwhite(srcp); |
| --dstlen; /* leave one char space for "\," */ |
| while (*src && dstlen > 0) |
| { |
| copy_char = TRUE; |
| if ((*src == '$' |
| #ifdef VMS |
| && at_start |
| #endif |
| ) |
| #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) |
| || *src == '%' |
| #endif |
| || (*src == '~' && at_start)) |
| { |
| mustfree = FALSE; |
| |
| /* |
| * The variable name is copied into dst temporarily, because it may |
| * be a string in read-only memory and a NUL needs to be appended. |
| */ |
| if (*src != '~') /* environment var */ |
| { |
| tail = src + 1; |
| var = dst; |
| c = dstlen - 1; |
| |
| #ifdef UNIX |
| /* Unix has ${var-name} type environment vars */ |
| if (*tail == '{' && !vim_isIDc('{')) |
| { |
| tail++; /* ignore '{' */ |
| while (c-- > 0 && *tail && *tail != '}') |
| *var++ = *tail++; |
| } |
| else |
| #endif |
| { |
| while (c-- > 0 && *tail != NUL && ((vim_isIDc(*tail)) |
| #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) |
| || (*src == '%' && *tail != '%') |
| #endif |
| )) |
| { |
| #ifdef OS2 /* env vars only in uppercase */ |
| *var++ = TOUPPER_LOC(*tail); |
| tail++; /* toupper() may be a macro! */ |
| #else |
| *var++ = *tail++; |
| #endif |
| } |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) || defined(UNIX) |
| # ifdef UNIX |
| if (src[1] == '{' && *tail != '}') |
| # else |
| if (*src == '%' && *tail != '%') |
| # endif |
| var = NULL; |
| else |
| { |
| # ifdef UNIX |
| if (src[1] == '{') |
| # else |
| if (*src == '%') |
| #endif |
| ++tail; |
| #endif |
| *var = NUL; |
| var = vim_getenv(dst, &mustfree); |
| #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) || defined(UNIX) |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| /* home directory */ |
| else if ( src[1] == NUL |
| || vim_ispathsep(src[1]) |
| || vim_strchr((char_u *)" ,\t\n", src[1]) != NULL) |
| { |
| var = homedir; |
| tail = src + 1; |
| } |
| else /* user directory */ |
| { |
| #if defined(UNIX) || (defined(VMS) && defined(USER_HOME)) |
| /* |
| * Copy ~user to dst[], so we can put a NUL after it. |
| */ |
| tail = src; |
| var = dst; |
| c = dstlen - 1; |
| while ( c-- > 0 |
| && *tail |
| && vim_isfilec(*tail) |
| && !vim_ispathsep(*tail)) |
| *var++ = *tail++; |
| *var = NUL; |
| # ifdef UNIX |
| /* |
| * If the system supports getpwnam(), use it. |
| * Otherwise, or if getpwnam() fails, the shell is used to |
| * expand ~user. This is slower and may fail if the shell |
| * does not support ~user (old versions of /bin/sh). |
| */ |
| # if defined(HAVE_GETPWNAM) && defined(HAVE_PWD_H) |
| { |
| struct passwd *pw; |
| |
| /* Note: memory allocated by getpwnam() is never freed. |
| * Calling endpwent() apparently doesn't help. */ |
| pw = getpwnam((char *)dst + 1); |
| if (pw != NULL) |
| var = (char_u *)pw->pw_dir; |
| else |
| var = NULL; |
| } |
| if (var == NULL) |
| # endif |
| { |
| expand_T xpc; |
| |
| ExpandInit(&xpc); |
| xpc.xp_context = EXPAND_FILES; |
| var = ExpandOne(&xpc, dst, NULL, |
| WILD_ADD_SLASH|WILD_SILENT, WILD_EXPAND_FREE); |
| mustfree = TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| # else /* !UNIX, thus VMS */ |
| /* |
| * USER_HOME is a comma-separated list of |
| * directories to search for the user account in. |
| */ |
| { |
| char_u test[MAXPATHL], paths[MAXPATHL]; |
| char_u *path, *next_path, *ptr; |
| struct stat st; |
| |
| STRCPY(paths, USER_HOME); |
| next_path = paths; |
| while (*next_path) |
| { |
| for (path = next_path; *next_path && *next_path != ','; |
| next_path++); |
| if (*next_path) |
| *next_path++ = NUL; |
| STRCPY(test, path); |
| STRCAT(test, "/"); |
| STRCAT(test, dst + 1); |
| if (mch_stat(test, &st) == 0) |
| { |
| var = alloc(STRLEN(test) + 1); |
| STRCPY(var, test); |
| mustfree = TRUE; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| # endif /* UNIX */ |
| #else |
| /* cannot expand user's home directory, so don't try */ |
| var = NULL; |
| tail = (char_u *)""; /* for gcc */ |
| #endif /* UNIX || VMS */ |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME |
| /* If 'shellslash' is set change backslashes to forward slashes. |
| * Can't use slash_adjust(), p_ssl may be set temporarily. */ |
| if (p_ssl && var != NULL && vim_strchr(var, '\\') != NULL) |
| { |
| char_u *p = vim_strsave(var); |
| |
| if (p != NULL) |
| { |
| if (mustfree) |
| vim_free(var); |
| var = p; |
| mustfree = TRUE; |
| forward_slash(var); |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* If "var" contains white space, escape it with a backslash. |
| * Required for ":e ~/tt" when $HOME includes a space. */ |
| if (esc && var != NULL && vim_strpbrk(var, (char_u *)" \t") != NULL) |
| { |
| char_u *p = vim_strsave_escaped(var, (char_u *)" \t"); |
| |
| if (p != NULL) |
| { |
| if (mustfree) |
| vim_free(var); |
| var = p; |
| mustfree = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (var != NULL && *var != NUL |
| && (STRLEN(var) + STRLEN(tail) + 1 < (unsigned)dstlen)) |
| { |
| STRCPY(dst, var); |
| dstlen -= (int)STRLEN(var); |
| c = (int)STRLEN(var); |
| /* if var[] ends in a path separator and tail[] starts |
| * with it, skip a character */ |
| if (*var != NUL && after_pathsep(dst, dst + c) |
| #if defined(BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME) || defined(AMIGA) |
| && dst[-1] != ':' |
| #endif |
| && vim_ispathsep(*tail)) |
| ++tail; |
| dst += c; |
| src = tail; |
| copy_char = FALSE; |
| } |
| if (mustfree) |
| vim_free(var); |
| } |
| |
| if (copy_char) /* copy at least one char */ |
| { |
| /* |
| * Recognize the start of a new name, for '~'. |
| * Don't do this when "one" is TRUE, to avoid expanding "~" in |
| * ":edit foo ~ foo". |
| */ |
| at_start = FALSE; |
| if (src[0] == '\\' && src[1] != NUL) |
| { |
| *dst++ = *src++; |
| --dstlen; |
| } |
| else if ((src[0] == ' ' || src[0] == ',') && !one) |
| at_start = TRUE; |
| *dst++ = *src++; |
| --dstlen; |
| |
| if (startstr != NULL && src - startstr_len >= srcp |
| && STRNCMP(src - startstr_len, startstr, startstr_len) == 0) |
| at_start = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| *dst = NUL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Vim's version of getenv(). |
| * Special handling of $HOME, $VIM and $VIMRUNTIME. |
| * Also does ACP to 'enc' conversion for Win32. |
| * "mustfree" is set to TRUE when returned is allocated, it must be |
| * initialized to FALSE by the caller. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| vim_getenv(name, mustfree) |
| char_u *name; |
| int *mustfree; |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| char_u *pend; |
| int vimruntime; |
| |
| #if defined(OS2) || defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) |
| /* use "C:/" when $HOME is not set */ |
| if (STRCMP(name, "HOME") == 0) |
| return homedir; |
| #endif |
| |
| p = mch_getenv(name); |
| if (p != NULL && *p == NUL) /* empty is the same as not set */ |
| p = NULL; |
| |
| if (p != NULL) |
| { |
| #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) && defined(WIN3264) |
| if (enc_utf8) |
| { |
| int len; |
| char_u *pp = NULL; |
| |
| /* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8. Other conversions are |
| * not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII characters. */ |
| acp_to_enc(p, (int)STRLEN(p), &pp, &len); |
| if (pp != NULL) |
| { |
| p = pp; |
| *mustfree = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| return p; |
| } |
| |
| vimruntime = (STRCMP(name, "VIMRUNTIME") == 0); |
| if (!vimruntime && STRCMP(name, "VIM") != 0) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| /* |
| * When expanding $VIMRUNTIME fails, try using $VIM/vim<version> or $VIM. |
| * Don't do this when default_vimruntime_dir is non-empty. |
| */ |
| if (vimruntime |
| #ifdef HAVE_PATHDEF |
| && *default_vimruntime_dir == NUL |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| p = mch_getenv((char_u *)"VIM"); |
| if (p != NULL && *p == NUL) /* empty is the same as not set */ |
| p = NULL; |
| if (p != NULL) |
| { |
| p = vim_version_dir(p); |
| if (p != NULL) |
| *mustfree = TRUE; |
| else |
| p = mch_getenv((char_u *)"VIM"); |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) && defined(WIN3264) |
| if (enc_utf8) |
| { |
| int len; |
| char_u *pp = NULL; |
| |
| /* Convert from active codepage to UTF-8. Other conversions |
| * are not done, because they would fail for non-ASCII |
| * characters. */ |
| acp_to_enc(p, (int)STRLEN(p), &pp, &len); |
| if (pp != NULL) |
| { |
| if (*mustfree) |
| vim_free(p); |
| p = pp; |
| *mustfree = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * When expanding $VIM or $VIMRUNTIME fails, try using: |
| * - the directory name from 'helpfile' (unless it contains '$') |
| * - the executable name from argv[0] |
| */ |
| if (p == NULL) |
| { |
| if (p_hf != NULL && vim_strchr(p_hf, '$') == NULL) |
| p = p_hf; |
| #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME |
| /* |
| * Use the name of the executable, obtained from argv[0]. |
| */ |
| else |
| p = exe_name; |
| #endif |
| if (p != NULL) |
| { |
| /* remove the file name */ |
| pend = gettail(p); |
| |
| /* remove "doc/" from 'helpfile', if present */ |
| if (p == p_hf) |
| pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"doc"); |
| |
| #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME |
| # ifdef MACOS_X |
| /* remove "MacOS" from exe_name and add "Resources/vim" */ |
| if (p == exe_name) |
| { |
| char_u *pend1; |
| char_u *pnew; |
| |
| pend1 = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"MacOS"); |
| if (pend1 != pend) |
| { |
| pnew = alloc((unsigned)(pend1 - p) + 15); |
| if (pnew != NULL) |
| { |
| STRNCPY(pnew, p, (pend1 - p)); |
| STRCPY(pnew + (pend1 - p), "Resources/vim"); |
| p = pnew; |
| pend = p + STRLEN(p); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| # endif |
| /* remove "src/" from exe_name, if present */ |
| if (p == exe_name) |
| pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)"src"); |
| #endif |
| |
| /* for $VIM, remove "runtime/" or "vim54/", if present */ |
| if (!vimruntime) |
| { |
| pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)RUNTIME_DIRNAME); |
| pend = remove_tail(p, pend, (char_u *)VIM_VERSION_NODOT); |
| } |
| |
| /* remove trailing path separator */ |
| #ifndef MACOS_CLASSIC |
| /* With MacOS path (with colons) the final colon is required */ |
| /* to avoid confusion between absolute and relative path */ |
| if (pend > p && after_pathsep(p, pend)) |
| --pend; |
| #endif |
| |
| #ifdef MACOS_X |
| if (p == exe_name || p == p_hf) |
| #endif |
| /* check that the result is a directory name */ |
| p = vim_strnsave(p, (int)(pend - p)); |
| |
| if (p != NULL && !mch_isdir(p)) |
| { |
| vim_free(p); |
| p = NULL; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME |
| /* may add "/vim54" or "/runtime" if it exists */ |
| if (vimruntime && (pend = vim_version_dir(p)) != NULL) |
| { |
| vim_free(p); |
| p = pend; |
| } |
| #endif |
| *mustfree = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef HAVE_PATHDEF |
| /* When there is a pathdef.c file we can use default_vim_dir and |
| * default_vimruntime_dir */ |
| if (p == NULL) |
| { |
| /* Only use default_vimruntime_dir when it is not empty */ |
| if (vimruntime && *default_vimruntime_dir != NUL) |
| { |
| p = default_vimruntime_dir; |
| *mustfree = FALSE; |
| } |
| else if (*default_vim_dir != NUL) |
| { |
| if (vimruntime && (p = vim_version_dir(default_vim_dir)) != NULL) |
| *mustfree = TRUE; |
| else |
| { |
| p = default_vim_dir; |
| *mustfree = FALSE; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Set the environment variable, so that the new value can be found fast |
| * next time, and others can also use it (e.g. Perl). |
| */ |
| if (p != NULL) |
| { |
| if (vimruntime) |
| { |
| vim_setenv((char_u *)"VIMRUNTIME", p); |
| didset_vimruntime = TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| vim_setenv((char_u *)"VIM", p); |
| didset_vim = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| return p; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check if the directory "vimdir/<version>" or "vimdir/runtime" exists. |
| * Return NULL if not, return its name in allocated memory otherwise. |
| */ |
| static char_u * |
| vim_version_dir(vimdir) |
| char_u *vimdir; |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| |
| if (vimdir == NULL || *vimdir == NUL) |
| return NULL; |
| p = concat_fnames(vimdir, (char_u *)VIM_VERSION_NODOT, TRUE); |
| if (p != NULL && mch_isdir(p)) |
| return p; |
| vim_free(p); |
| p = concat_fnames(vimdir, (char_u *)RUNTIME_DIRNAME, TRUE); |
| if (p != NULL && mch_isdir(p)) |
| return p; |
| vim_free(p); |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the string between "p" and "pend" ends in "name/", return "pend" minus |
| * the length of "name/". Otherwise return "pend". |
| */ |
| static char_u * |
| remove_tail(p, pend, name) |
| char_u *p; |
| char_u *pend; |
| char_u *name; |
| { |
| int len = (int)STRLEN(name) + 1; |
| char_u *newend = pend - len; |
| |
| if (newend >= p |
| && fnamencmp(newend, name, len - 1) == 0 |
| && (newend == p || after_pathsep(p, newend))) |
| return newend; |
| return pend; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Our portable version of setenv. |
| */ |
| void |
| vim_setenv(name, val) |
| char_u *name; |
| char_u *val; |
| { |
| #ifdef HAVE_SETENV |
| mch_setenv((char *)name, (char *)val, 1); |
| #else |
| char_u *envbuf; |
| |
| /* |
| * Putenv does not copy the string, it has to remain |
| * valid. The allocated memory will never be freed. |
| */ |
| envbuf = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(name) + STRLEN(val) + 2)); |
| if (envbuf != NULL) |
| { |
| sprintf((char *)envbuf, "%s=%s", name, val); |
| putenv((char *)envbuf); |
| } |
| #endif |
| #ifdef FEAT_GETTEXT |
| /* |
| * When setting $VIMRUNTIME adjust the directory to find message |
| * translations to $VIMRUNTIME/lang. |
| */ |
| if (*val != NUL && STRICMP(name, "VIMRUNTIME") == 0) |
| { |
| char_u *buf = concat_str(val, (char_u *)"/lang"); |
| |
| if (buf != NULL) |
| { |
| bindtextdomain(VIMPACKAGE, (char *)buf); |
| vim_free(buf); |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Function given to ExpandGeneric() to obtain an environment variable name. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| get_env_name(xp, idx) |
| expand_T *xp UNUSED; |
| int idx; |
| { |
| # if defined(AMIGA) || defined(__MRC__) || defined(__SC__) |
| /* |
| * No environ[] on the Amiga and on the Mac (using MPW). |
| */ |
| return NULL; |
| # else |
| # ifndef __WIN32__ |
| /* Borland C++ 5.2 has this in a header file. */ |
| extern char **environ; |
| # endif |
| # define ENVNAMELEN 100 |
| static char_u name[ENVNAMELEN]; |
| char_u *str; |
| int n; |
| |
| str = (char_u *)environ[idx]; |
| if (str == NULL) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| for (n = 0; n < ENVNAMELEN - 1; ++n) |
| { |
| if (str[n] == '=' || str[n] == NUL) |
| break; |
| name[n] = str[n]; |
| } |
| name[n] = NUL; |
| return name; |
| # endif |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Find all user names for user completion. |
| * Done only once and then cached. |
| */ |
| static void |
| init_users() { |
| static int lazy_init_done = FALSE; |
| |
| if (lazy_init_done) |
| return; |
| |
| lazy_init_done = TRUE; |
| ga_init2(&ga_users, sizeof(char_u *), 20); |
| |
| # if defined(HAVE_GETPWENT) && defined(HAVE_PWD_H) |
| { |
| char_u* user; |
| struct passwd* pw; |
| |
| setpwent(); |
| while ((pw = getpwent()) != NULL) |
| /* pw->pw_name shouldn't be NULL but just in case... */ |
| if (pw->pw_name != NULL) |
| { |
| if (ga_grow(&ga_users, 1) == FAIL) |
| break; |
| user = vim_strsave((char_u*)pw->pw_name); |
| if (user == NULL) |
| break; |
| ((char_u **)(ga_users.ga_data))[ga_users.ga_len++] = user; |
| } |
| endpwent(); |
| } |
| # endif |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Function given to ExpandGeneric() to obtain an user names. |
| */ |
| char_u* |
| get_users(xp, idx) |
| expand_T *xp UNUSED; |
| int idx; |
| { |
| init_users(); |
| if (idx < ga_users.ga_len) |
| return ((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[idx]; |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check whether name matches a user name. Return: |
| * 0 if name does not match any user name. |
| * 1 if name partially matches the beginning of a user name. |
| * 2 is name fully matches a user name. |
| */ |
| int match_user(name) |
| char_u* name; |
| { |
| int i; |
| int n = (int)STRLEN(name); |
| int result = 0; |
| |
| init_users(); |
| for (i = 0; i < ga_users.ga_len; i++) |
| { |
| if (STRCMP(((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[i], name) == 0) |
| return 2; /* full match */ |
| if (STRNCMP(((char_u **)ga_users.ga_data)[i], name, n) == 0) |
| result = 1; /* partial match */ |
| } |
| return result; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Replace home directory by "~" in each space or comma separated file name in |
| * 'src'. |
| * If anything fails (except when out of space) dst equals src. |
| */ |
| void |
| home_replace(buf, src, dst, dstlen, one) |
| buf_T *buf; /* when not NULL, check for help files */ |
| char_u *src; /* input file name */ |
| char_u *dst; /* where to put the result */ |
| int dstlen; /* maximum length of the result */ |
| int one; /* if TRUE, only replace one file name, include |
| spaces and commas in the file name. */ |
| { |
| size_t dirlen = 0, envlen = 0; |
| size_t len; |
| char_u *homedir_env, *homedir_env_orig; |
| char_u *p; |
| |
| if (src == NULL) |
| { |
| *dst = NUL; |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the file is a help file, remove the path completely. |
| */ |
| if (buf != NULL && buf->b_help) |
| { |
| STRCPY(dst, gettail(src)); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * We check both the value of the $HOME environment variable and the |
| * "real" home directory. |
| */ |
| if (homedir != NULL) |
| dirlen = STRLEN(homedir); |
| |
| #ifdef VMS |
| homedir_env_orig = homedir_env = mch_getenv((char_u *)"SYS$LOGIN"); |
| #else |
| homedir_env_orig = homedir_env = mch_getenv((char_u *)"HOME"); |
| #endif |
| /* Empty is the same as not set. */ |
| if (homedir_env != NULL && *homedir_env == NUL) |
| homedir_env = NULL; |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_MODIFY_FNAME) || defined(WIN3264) |
| if (homedir_env != NULL && vim_strchr(homedir_env, '~') != NULL) |
| { |
| int usedlen = 0; |
| int flen; |
| char_u *fbuf = NULL; |
| |
| flen = (int)STRLEN(homedir_env); |
| (void)modify_fname((char_u *)":p", &usedlen, |
| &homedir_env, &fbuf, &flen); |
| flen = (int)STRLEN(homedir_env); |
| if (flen > 0 && vim_ispathsep(homedir_env[flen - 1])) |
| /* Remove the trailing / that is added to a directory. */ |
| homedir_env[flen - 1] = NUL; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| if (homedir_env != NULL) |
| envlen = STRLEN(homedir_env); |
| |
| if (!one) |
| src = skipwhite(src); |
| while (*src && dstlen > 0) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Here we are at the beginning of a file name. |
| * First, check to see if the beginning of the file name matches |
| * $HOME or the "real" home directory. Check that there is a '/' |
| * after the match (so that if e.g. the file is "/home/pieter/bla", |
| * and the home directory is "/home/piet", the file does not end up |
| * as "~er/bla" (which would seem to indicate the file "bla" in user |
| * er's home directory)). |
| */ |
| p = homedir; |
| len = dirlen; |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| if ( len |
| && fnamencmp(src, p, len) == 0 |
| && (vim_ispathsep(src[len]) |
| || (!one && (src[len] == ',' || src[len] == ' ')) |
| || src[len] == NUL)) |
| { |
| src += len; |
| if (--dstlen > 0) |
| *dst++ = '~'; |
| |
| /* |
| * If it's just the home directory, add "/". |
| */ |
| if (!vim_ispathsep(src[0]) && --dstlen > 0) |
| *dst++ = '/'; |
| break; |
| } |
| if (p == homedir_env) |
| break; |
| p = homedir_env; |
| len = envlen; |
| } |
| |
| /* if (!one) skip to separator: space or comma */ |
| while (*src && (one || (*src != ',' && *src != ' ')) && --dstlen > 0) |
| *dst++ = *src++; |
| /* skip separator */ |
| while ((*src == ' ' || *src == ',') && --dstlen > 0) |
| *dst++ = *src++; |
| } |
| /* if (dstlen == 0) out of space, what to do??? */ |
| |
| *dst = NUL; |
| |
| if (homedir_env != homedir_env_orig) |
| vim_free(homedir_env); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Like home_replace, store the replaced string in allocated memory. |
| * When something fails, NULL is returned. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| home_replace_save(buf, src) |
| buf_T *buf; /* when not NULL, check for help files */ |
| char_u *src; /* input file name */ |
| { |
| char_u *dst; |
| unsigned len; |
| |
| len = 3; /* space for "~/" and trailing NUL */ |
| if (src != NULL) /* just in case */ |
| len += (unsigned)STRLEN(src); |
| dst = alloc(len); |
| if (dst != NULL) |
| home_replace(buf, src, dst, len, TRUE); |
| return dst; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Compare two file names and return: |
| * FPC_SAME if they both exist and are the same file. |
| * FPC_SAMEX if they both don't exist and have the same file name. |
| * FPC_DIFF if they both exist and are different files. |
| * FPC_NOTX if they both don't exist. |
| * FPC_DIFFX if one of them doesn't exist. |
| * For the first name environment variables are expanded |
| */ |
| int |
| fullpathcmp(s1, s2, checkname) |
| char_u *s1, *s2; |
| int checkname; /* when both don't exist, check file names */ |
| { |
| #ifdef UNIX |
| char_u exp1[MAXPATHL]; |
| char_u full1[MAXPATHL]; |
| char_u full2[MAXPATHL]; |
| struct stat st1, st2; |
| int r1, r2; |
| |
| expand_env(s1, exp1, MAXPATHL); |
| r1 = mch_stat((char *)exp1, &st1); |
| r2 = mch_stat((char *)s2, &st2); |
| if (r1 != 0 && r2 != 0) |
| { |
| /* if mch_stat() doesn't work, may compare the names */ |
| if (checkname) |
| { |
| if (fnamecmp(exp1, s2) == 0) |
| return FPC_SAMEX; |
| r1 = vim_FullName(exp1, full1, MAXPATHL, FALSE); |
| r2 = vim_FullName(s2, full2, MAXPATHL, FALSE); |
| if (r1 == OK && r2 == OK && fnamecmp(full1, full2) == 0) |
| return FPC_SAMEX; |
| } |
| return FPC_NOTX; |
| } |
| if (r1 != 0 || r2 != 0) |
| return FPC_DIFFX; |
| if (st1.st_dev == st2.st_dev && st1.st_ino == st2.st_ino) |
| return FPC_SAME; |
| return FPC_DIFF; |
| #else |
| char_u *exp1; /* expanded s1 */ |
| char_u *full1; /* full path of s1 */ |
| char_u *full2; /* full path of s2 */ |
| int retval = FPC_DIFF; |
| int r1, r2; |
| |
| /* allocate one buffer to store three paths (alloc()/free() is slow!) */ |
| if ((exp1 = alloc(MAXPATHL * 3)) != NULL) |
| { |
| full1 = exp1 + MAXPATHL; |
| full2 = full1 + MAXPATHL; |
| |
| expand_env(s1, exp1, MAXPATHL); |
| r1 = vim_FullName(exp1, full1, MAXPATHL, FALSE); |
| r2 = vim_FullName(s2, full2, MAXPATHL, FALSE); |
| |
| /* If vim_FullName() fails, the file probably doesn't exist. */ |
| if (r1 != OK && r2 != OK) |
| { |
| if (checkname && fnamecmp(exp1, s2) == 0) |
| retval = FPC_SAMEX; |
| else |
| retval = FPC_NOTX; |
| } |
| else if (r1 != OK || r2 != OK) |
| retval = FPC_DIFFX; |
| else if (fnamecmp(full1, full2)) |
| retval = FPC_DIFF; |
| else |
| retval = FPC_SAME; |
| vim_free(exp1); |
| } |
| return retval; |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get the tail of a path: the file name. |
| * When the path ends in a path separator the tail is the NUL after it. |
| * Fail safe: never returns NULL. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| gettail(fname) |
| char_u *fname; |
| { |
| char_u *p1, *p2; |
| |
| if (fname == NULL) |
| return (char_u *)""; |
| for (p1 = p2 = fname; *p2; ) /* find last part of path */ |
| { |
| if (vim_ispathsep(*p2)) |
| p1 = p2 + 1; |
| mb_ptr_adv(p2); |
| } |
| return p1; |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) |
| static char_u *gettail_dir __ARGS((char_u *fname)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the end of the directory name, on the first path |
| * separator: |
| * "/path/file", "/path/dir/", "/path//dir", "/file" |
| * ^ ^ ^ ^ |
| */ |
| static char_u * |
| gettail_dir(fname) |
| char_u *fname; |
| { |
| char_u *dir_end = fname; |
| char_u *next_dir_end = fname; |
| int look_for_sep = TRUE; |
| char_u *p; |
| |
| for (p = fname; *p != NUL; ) |
| { |
| if (vim_ispathsep(*p)) |
| { |
| if (look_for_sep) |
| { |
| next_dir_end = p; |
| look_for_sep = FALSE; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (!look_for_sep) |
| dir_end = next_dir_end; |
| look_for_sep = TRUE; |
| } |
| mb_ptr_adv(p); |
| } |
| return dir_end; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Get pointer to tail of "fname", including path separators. Putting a NUL |
| * here leaves the directory name. Takes care of "c:/" and "//". |
| * Always returns a valid pointer. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| gettail_sep(fname) |
| char_u *fname; |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| char_u *t; |
| |
| p = get_past_head(fname); /* don't remove the '/' from "c:/file" */ |
| t = gettail(fname); |
| while (t > p && after_pathsep(fname, t)) |
| --t; |
| #ifdef VMS |
| /* path separator is part of the path */ |
| ++t; |
| #endif |
| return t; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * get the next path component (just after the next path separator). |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| getnextcomp(fname) |
| char_u *fname; |
| { |
| while (*fname && !vim_ispathsep(*fname)) |
| mb_ptr_adv(fname); |
| if (*fname) |
| ++fname; |
| return fname; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get a pointer to one character past the head of a path name. |
| * Unix: after "/"; DOS: after "c:\"; Amiga: after "disk:/"; Mac: no head. |
| * If there is no head, path is returned. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| get_past_head(path) |
| char_u *path; |
| { |
| char_u *retval; |
| |
| #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(MSWIN) || defined(OS2) |
| /* may skip "c:" */ |
| if (isalpha(path[0]) && path[1] == ':') |
| retval = path + 2; |
| else |
| retval = path; |
| #else |
| # if defined(AMIGA) |
| /* may skip "label:" */ |
| retval = vim_strchr(path, ':'); |
| if (retval == NULL) |
| retval = path; |
| # else /* Unix */ |
| retval = path; |
| # endif |
| #endif |
| |
| while (vim_ispathsep(*retval)) |
| ++retval; |
| |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * return TRUE if 'c' is a path separator. |
| */ |
| int |
| vim_ispathsep(c) |
| int c; |
| { |
| #ifdef UNIX |
| return (c == '/'); /* UNIX has ':' inside file names */ |
| #else |
| # ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME |
| return (c == ':' || c == '/' || c == '\\'); |
| # else |
| # ifdef VMS |
| /* server"user passwd"::device:[full.path.name]fname.extension;version" */ |
| return (c == ':' || c == '[' || c == ']' || c == '/' |
| || c == '<' || c == '>' || c == '"' ); |
| # else |
| return (c == ':' || c == '/'); |
| # endif /* VMS */ |
| # endif |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * return TRUE if 'c' is a path list separator. |
| */ |
| int |
| vim_ispathlistsep(c) |
| int c; |
| { |
| #ifdef UNIX |
| return (c == ':'); |
| #else |
| return (c == ';'); /* might not be right for every system... */ |
| #endif |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_GUI_TABLINE) || defined(FEAT_WINDOWS) \ |
| || defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Shorten the path of a file from "~/foo/../.bar/fname" to "~/f/../.b/fname" |
| * It's done in-place. |
| */ |
| void |
| shorten_dir(str) |
| char_u *str; |
| { |
| char_u *tail, *s, *d; |
| int skip = FALSE; |
| |
| tail = gettail(str); |
| d = str; |
| for (s = str; ; ++s) |
| { |
| if (s >= tail) /* copy the whole tail */ |
| { |
| *d++ = *s; |
| if (*s == NUL) |
| break; |
| } |
| else if (vim_ispathsep(*s)) /* copy '/' and next char */ |
| { |
| *d++ = *s; |
| skip = FALSE; |
| } |
| else if (!skip) |
| { |
| *d++ = *s; /* copy next char */ |
| if (*s != '~' && *s != '.') /* and leading "~" and "." */ |
| skip = TRUE; |
| # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| { |
| int l = mb_ptr2len(s); |
| |
| while (--l > 0) |
| *d++ = *++s; |
| } |
| # endif |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE if the directory of "fname" exists, FALSE otherwise. |
| * Also returns TRUE if there is no directory name. |
| * "fname" must be writable!. |
| */ |
| int |
| dir_of_file_exists(fname) |
| char_u *fname; |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| int c; |
| int retval; |
| |
| p = gettail_sep(fname); |
| if (p == fname) |
| return TRUE; |
| c = *p; |
| *p = NUL; |
| retval = mch_isdir(fname); |
| *p = c; |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| #if (defined(CASE_INSENSITIVE_FILENAME) && defined(BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME)) \ |
| || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Versions of fnamecmp() and fnamencmp() that handle '/' and '\' equally. |
| */ |
| int |
| vim_fnamecmp(x, y) |
| char_u *x, *y; |
| { |
| return vim_fnamencmp(x, y, MAXPATHL); |
| } |
| |
| int |
| vim_fnamencmp(x, y, len) |
| char_u *x, *y; |
| size_t len; |
| { |
| while (len > 0 && *x && *y) |
| { |
| if (TOLOWER_LOC(*x) != TOLOWER_LOC(*y) |
| && !(*x == '/' && *y == '\\') |
| && !(*x == '\\' && *y == '/')) |
| break; |
| ++x; |
| ++y; |
| --len; |
| } |
| if (len == 0) |
| return 0; |
| return (*x - *y); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Concatenate file names fname1 and fname2 into allocated memory. |
| * Only add a '/' or '\\' when 'sep' is TRUE and it is necessary. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| concat_fnames(fname1, fname2, sep) |
| char_u *fname1; |
| char_u *fname2; |
| int sep; |
| { |
| char_u *dest; |
| |
| dest = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(fname1) + STRLEN(fname2) + 3)); |
| if (dest != NULL) |
| { |
| STRCPY(dest, fname1); |
| if (sep) |
| add_pathsep(dest); |
| STRCAT(dest, fname2); |
| } |
| return dest; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Concatenate two strings and return the result in allocated memory. |
| * Returns NULL when out of memory. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| concat_str(str1, str2) |
| char_u *str1; |
| char_u *str2; |
| { |
| char_u *dest; |
| size_t l = STRLEN(str1); |
| |
| dest = alloc((unsigned)(l + STRLEN(str2) + 1L)); |
| if (dest != NULL) |
| { |
| STRCPY(dest, str1); |
| STRCPY(dest + l, str2); |
| } |
| return dest; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Add a path separator to a file name, unless it already ends in a path |
| * separator. |
| */ |
| void |
| add_pathsep(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| if (*p != NUL && !after_pathsep(p, p + STRLEN(p))) |
| STRCAT(p, PATHSEPSTR); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * FullName_save - Make an allocated copy of a full file name. |
| * Returns NULL when out of memory. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| FullName_save(fname, force) |
| char_u *fname; |
| int force; /* force expansion, even when it already looks |
| * like a full path name */ |
| { |
| char_u *buf; |
| char_u *new_fname = NULL; |
| |
| if (fname == NULL) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| buf = alloc((unsigned)MAXPATHL); |
| if (buf != NULL) |
| { |
| if (vim_FullName(fname, buf, MAXPATHL, force) != FAIL) |
| new_fname = vim_strsave(buf); |
| else |
| new_fname = vim_strsave(fname); |
| vim_free(buf); |
| } |
| return new_fname; |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(FEAT_SYN_HL) |
| |
| static char_u *skip_string __ARGS((char_u *p)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Find the start of a comment, not knowing if we are in a comment right now. |
| * Search starts at w_cursor.lnum and goes backwards. |
| */ |
| pos_T * |
| find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment) /* XXX */ |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| { |
| pos_T *pos; |
| char_u *line; |
| char_u *p; |
| int cur_maxcomment = ind_maxcomment; |
| |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| pos = findmatchlimit(NULL, '*', FM_BACKWARD, cur_maxcomment); |
| if (pos == NULL) |
| break; |
| |
| /* |
| * Check if the comment start we found is inside a string. |
| * If it is then restrict the search to below this line and try again. |
| */ |
| line = ml_get(pos->lnum); |
| for (p = line; *p && (colnr_T)(p - line) < pos->col; ++p) |
| p = skip_string(p); |
| if ((colnr_T)(p - line) <= pos->col) |
| break; |
| cur_maxcomment = curwin->w_cursor.lnum - pos->lnum - 1; |
| if (cur_maxcomment <= 0) |
| { |
| pos = NULL; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| return pos; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Skip to the end of a "string" and a 'c' character. |
| * If there is no string or character, return argument unmodified. |
| */ |
| static char_u * |
| skip_string(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| int i; |
| |
| /* |
| * We loop, because strings may be concatenated: "date""time". |
| */ |
| for ( ; ; ++p) |
| { |
| if (p[0] == '\'') /* 'c' or '\n' or '\000' */ |
| { |
| if (!p[1]) /* ' at end of line */ |
| break; |
| i = 2; |
| if (p[1] == '\\') /* '\n' or '\000' */ |
| { |
| ++i; |
| while (vim_isdigit(p[i - 1])) /* '\000' */ |
| ++i; |
| } |
| if (p[i] == '\'') /* check for trailing ' */ |
| { |
| p += i; |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| else if (p[0] == '"') /* start of string */ |
| { |
| for (++p; p[0]; ++p) |
| { |
| if (p[0] == '\\' && p[1] != NUL) |
| ++p; |
| else if (p[0] == '"') /* end of string */ |
| break; |
| } |
| if (p[0] == '"') |
| continue; |
| } |
| break; /* no string found */ |
| } |
| if (!*p) |
| --p; /* backup from NUL */ |
| return p; |
| } |
| #endif /* FEAT_CINDENT || FEAT_SYN_HL */ |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_CINDENT) || defined(PROTO) |
| |
| /* |
| * Do C or expression indenting on the current line. |
| */ |
| void |
| do_c_expr_indent() |
| { |
| # ifdef FEAT_EVAL |
| if (*curbuf->b_p_inde != NUL) |
| fixthisline(get_expr_indent); |
| else |
| # endif |
| fixthisline(get_c_indent); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Functions for C-indenting. |
| * Most of this originally comes from Eric Fischer. |
| */ |
| /* |
| * Below "XXX" means that this function may unlock the current line. |
| */ |
| |
| static char_u *cin_skipcomment __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static int cin_nocode __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static pos_T *find_line_comment __ARGS((void)); |
| static int cin_islabel_skip __ARGS((char_u **)); |
| static int cin_isdefault __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static char_u *after_label __ARGS((char_u *l)); |
| static int get_indent_nolabel __ARGS((linenr_T lnum)); |
| static int skip_label __ARGS((linenr_T, char_u **pp, int ind_maxcomment)); |
| static int cin_first_id_amount __ARGS((void)); |
| static int cin_get_equal_amount __ARGS((linenr_T lnum)); |
| static int cin_ispreproc __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static int cin_ispreproc_cont __ARGS((char_u **pp, linenr_T *lnump)); |
| static int cin_iscomment __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static int cin_islinecomment __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static int cin_isterminated __ARGS((char_u *, int, int)); |
| static int cin_isinit __ARGS((void)); |
| static int cin_isfuncdecl __ARGS((char_u **, linenr_T, linenr_T, int, int)); |
| static int cin_isif __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static int cin_iselse __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static int cin_isdo __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static int cin_iswhileofdo __ARGS((char_u *, linenr_T, int)); |
| static int cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset __ARGS((char_u *line, int *poffset)); |
| static int cin_iswhileofdo_end __ARGS((int terminated, int ind_maxparen, int ind_maxcomment)); |
| static int cin_isbreak __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| static int cin_is_cpp_baseclass __ARGS((colnr_T *col)); |
| static int get_baseclass_amount __ARGS((int col, int ind_maxparen, int ind_maxcomment, int ind_cpp_baseclass)); |
| static int cin_ends_in __ARGS((char_u *, char_u *, char_u *)); |
| static int cin_skip2pos __ARGS((pos_T *trypos)); |
| static pos_T *find_start_brace __ARGS((int)); |
| static pos_T *find_match_paren __ARGS((int, int)); |
| static int corr_ind_maxparen __ARGS((int ind_maxparen, pos_T *startpos)); |
| static int find_last_paren __ARGS((char_u *l, int start, int end)); |
| static int find_match __ARGS((int lookfor, linenr_T ourscope, int ind_maxparen, int ind_maxcomment)); |
| static int cin_is_cpp_namespace __ARGS((char_u *)); |
| |
| static int ind_hash_comment = 0; /* # starts a comment */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Skip over white space and C comments within the line. |
| * Also skip over Perl/shell comments if desired. |
| */ |
| static char_u * |
| cin_skipcomment(s) |
| char_u *s; |
| { |
| while (*s) |
| { |
| char_u *prev_s = s; |
| |
| s = skipwhite(s); |
| |
| /* Perl/shell # comment comment continues until eol. Require a space |
| * before # to avoid recognizing $#array. */ |
| if (ind_hash_comment != 0 && s != prev_s && *s == '#') |
| { |
| s += STRLEN(s); |
| break; |
| } |
| if (*s != '/') |
| break; |
| ++s; |
| if (*s == '/') /* slash-slash comment continues till eol */ |
| { |
| s += STRLEN(s); |
| break; |
| } |
| if (*s != '*') |
| break; |
| for (++s; *s; ++s) /* skip slash-star comment */ |
| if (s[0] == '*' && s[1] == '/') |
| { |
| s += 2; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| return s; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE if there is no code at *s. White space and comments are |
| * not considered code. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_nocode(s) |
| char_u *s; |
| { |
| return *cin_skipcomment(s) == NUL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check previous lines for a "//" line comment, skipping over blank lines. |
| */ |
| static pos_T * |
| find_line_comment() /* XXX */ |
| { |
| static pos_T pos; |
| char_u *line; |
| char_u *p; |
| |
| pos = curwin->w_cursor; |
| while (--pos.lnum > 0) |
| { |
| line = ml_get(pos.lnum); |
| p = skipwhite(line); |
| if (cin_islinecomment(p)) |
| { |
| pos.col = (int)(p - line); |
| return &pos; |
| } |
| if (*p != NUL) |
| break; |
| } |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check if string matches "label:"; move to character after ':' if true. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_islabel_skip(s) |
| char_u **s; |
| { |
| if (!vim_isIDc(**s)) /* need at least one ID character */ |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| while (vim_isIDc(**s)) |
| (*s)++; |
| |
| *s = cin_skipcomment(*s); |
| |
| /* "::" is not a label, it's C++ */ |
| return (**s == ':' && *++*s != ':'); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize a label: "label:". |
| * Note: curwin->w_cursor must be where we are looking for the label. |
| */ |
| int |
| cin_islabel(ind_maxcomment) /* XXX */ |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| { |
| char_u *s; |
| |
| s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); |
| |
| /* |
| * Exclude "default" from labels, since it should be indented |
| * like a switch label. Same for C++ scope declarations. |
| */ |
| if (cin_isdefault(s)) |
| return FALSE; |
| if (cin_isscopedecl(s)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| if (cin_islabel_skip(&s)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Only accept a label if the previous line is terminated or is a case |
| * label. |
| */ |
| pos_T cursor_save; |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| char_u *line; |
| |
| cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; |
| while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) |
| { |
| --curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're in a comment now, skip to the start of the comment. |
| */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| if ((trypos = find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) /* XXX */ |
| curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; |
| |
| line = ml_get_curline(); |
| if (cin_ispreproc(line)) /* ignore #defines, #if, etc. */ |
| continue; |
| if (*(line = cin_skipcomment(line)) == NUL) |
| continue; |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; |
| if (cin_isterminated(line, TRUE, FALSE) |
| || cin_isscopedecl(line) |
| || cin_iscase(line, TRUE) |
| || (cin_islabel_skip(&line) && cin_nocode(line))) |
| return TRUE; |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; |
| return TRUE; /* label at start of file??? */ |
| } |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize structure initialization and enumerations. |
| * Q&D-Implementation: |
| * check for "=" at end or "[typedef] enum" at beginning of line. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_isinit(void) |
| { |
| char_u *s; |
| |
| s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); |
| |
| if (STRNCMP(s, "typedef", 7) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[7])) |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 7); |
| |
| if (STRNCMP(s, "static", 6) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[6])) |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 6); |
| |
| if (STRNCMP(s, "enum", 4) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[4])) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| if (cin_ends_in(s, (char_u *)"=", (char_u *)"{")) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize a switch label: "case .*:" or "default:". |
| */ |
| int |
| cin_iscase(s, strict) |
| char_u *s; |
| int strict; /* Allow relaxed check of case statement for JS */ |
| { |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| if (STRNCMP(s, "case", 4) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[4])) |
| { |
| for (s += 4; *s; ++s) |
| { |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| if (*s == ':') |
| { |
| if (s[1] == ':') /* skip over "::" for C++ */ |
| ++s; |
| else |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| if (*s == '\'' && s[1] && s[2] == '\'') |
| s += 2; /* skip over ':' */ |
| else if (*s == '/' && (s[1] == '*' || s[1] == '/')) |
| return FALSE; /* stop at comment */ |
| else if (*s == '"') |
| { |
| /* JS etc. */ |
| if (strict) |
| return FALSE; /* stop at string */ |
| else |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| if (cin_isdefault(s)) |
| return TRUE; |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize a "default" switch label. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_isdefault(s) |
| char_u *s; |
| { |
| return (STRNCMP(s, "default", 7) == 0 |
| && *(s = cin_skipcomment(s + 7)) == ':' |
| && s[1] != ':'); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize a "public/private/protected" scope declaration label. |
| */ |
| int |
| cin_isscopedecl(s) |
| char_u *s; |
| { |
| int i; |
| |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| if (STRNCMP(s, "public", 6) == 0) |
| i = 6; |
| else if (STRNCMP(s, "protected", 9) == 0) |
| i = 9; |
| else if (STRNCMP(s, "private", 7) == 0) |
| i = 7; |
| else |
| return FALSE; |
| return (*(s = cin_skipcomment(s + i)) == ':' && s[1] != ':'); |
| } |
| |
| /* Maximum number of lines to search back for a "namespace" line. */ |
| #define FIND_NAMESPACE_LIM 20 |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize a "namespace" scope declaration. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_is_cpp_namespace(s) |
| char_u *s; |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| int has_name = FALSE; |
| |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| if (STRNCMP(s, "namespace", 9) == 0 && (s[9] == NUL || !vim_iswordc(s[9]))) |
| { |
| p = cin_skipcomment(skipwhite(s + 9)); |
| while (*p != NUL) |
| { |
| if (vim_iswhite(*p)) |
| { |
| has_name = TRUE; /* found end of a name */ |
| p = cin_skipcomment(skipwhite(p)); |
| } |
| else if (*p == '{') |
| { |
| break; |
| } |
| else if (vim_iswordc(*p)) |
| { |
| if (has_name) |
| return FALSE; /* word character after skipping past name */ |
| ++p; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| } |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return a pointer to the first non-empty non-comment character after a ':'. |
| * Return NULL if not found. |
| * case 234: a = b; |
| * ^ |
| */ |
| static char_u * |
| after_label(l) |
| char_u *l; |
| { |
| for ( ; *l; ++l) |
| { |
| if (*l == ':') |
| { |
| if (l[1] == ':') /* skip over "::" for C++ */ |
| ++l; |
| else if (!cin_iscase(l + 1, FALSE)) |
| break; |
| } |
| else if (*l == '\'' && l[1] && l[2] == '\'') |
| l += 2; /* skip over 'x' */ |
| } |
| if (*l == NUL) |
| return NULL; |
| l = cin_skipcomment(l + 1); |
| if (*l == NUL) |
| return NULL; |
| return l; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get indent of line "lnum", skipping a label. |
| * Return 0 if there is nothing after the label. |
| */ |
| static int |
| get_indent_nolabel(lnum) /* XXX */ |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| char_u *l; |
| pos_T fp; |
| colnr_T col; |
| char_u *p; |
| |
| l = ml_get(lnum); |
| p = after_label(l); |
| if (p == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| fp.col = (colnr_T)(p - l); |
| fp.lnum = lnum; |
| getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| return (int)col; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Find indent for line "lnum", ignoring any case or jump label. |
| * Also return a pointer to the text (after the label) in "pp". |
| * label: if (asdf && asdfasdf) |
| * ^ |
| */ |
| static int |
| skip_label(lnum, pp, ind_maxcomment) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| char_u **pp; |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| { |
| char_u *l; |
| int amount; |
| pos_T cursor_save; |
| |
| cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum; |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| /* XXX */ |
| if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l) |
| || cin_islabel(ind_maxcomment)) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent_nolabel(lnum); |
| l = after_label(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (l == NULL) /* just in case */ |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| amount = get_indent(); |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| } |
| *pp = l; |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; |
| return amount; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the indent of the first variable name after a type in a declaration. |
| * int a, indent of "a" |
| * static struct foo b, indent of "b" |
| * enum bla c, indent of "c" |
| * Returns zero when it doesn't look like a declaration. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_first_id_amount() |
| { |
| char_u *line, *p, *s; |
| int len; |
| pos_T fp; |
| colnr_T col; |
| |
| line = ml_get_curline(); |
| p = skipwhite(line); |
| len = (int)(skiptowhite(p) - p); |
| if (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "static", 6) == 0) |
| { |
| p = skipwhite(p + 6); |
| len = (int)(skiptowhite(p) - p); |
| } |
| if (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "struct", 6) == 0) |
| p = skipwhite(p + 6); |
| else if (len == 4 && STRNCMP(p, "enum", 4) == 0) |
| p = skipwhite(p + 4); |
| else if ((len == 8 && STRNCMP(p, "unsigned", 8) == 0) |
| || (len == 6 && STRNCMP(p, "signed", 6) == 0)) |
| { |
| s = skipwhite(p + len); |
| if ((STRNCMP(s, "int", 3) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[3])) |
| || (STRNCMP(s, "long", 4) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[4])) |
| || (STRNCMP(s, "short", 5) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[5])) |
| || (STRNCMP(s, "char", 4) == 0 && vim_iswhite(s[4]))) |
| p = s; |
| } |
| for (len = 0; vim_isIDc(p[len]); ++len) |
| ; |
| if (len == 0 || !vim_iswhite(p[len]) || cin_nocode(p)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| p = skipwhite(p + len); |
| fp.lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| fp.col = (colnr_T)(p - line); |
| getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| return (int)col; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the indent of the first non-blank after an equal sign. |
| * char *foo = "here"; |
| * Return zero if no (useful) equal sign found. |
| * Return -1 if the line above "lnum" ends in a backslash. |
| * foo = "asdf\ |
| * asdf\ |
| * here"; |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_get_equal_amount(lnum) |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| { |
| char_u *line; |
| char_u *s; |
| colnr_T col; |
| pos_T fp; |
| |
| if (lnum > 1) |
| { |
| line = ml_get(lnum - 1); |
| if (*line != NUL && line[STRLEN(line) - 1] == '\\') |
| return -1; |
| } |
| |
| line = s = ml_get(lnum); |
| while (*s != NUL && vim_strchr((char_u *)"=;{}\"'", *s) == NULL) |
| { |
| if (cin_iscomment(s)) /* ignore comments */ |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| else |
| ++s; |
| } |
| if (*s != '=') |
| return 0; |
| |
| s = skipwhite(s + 1); |
| if (cin_nocode(s)) |
| return 0; |
| |
| if (*s == '"') /* nice alignment for continued strings */ |
| ++s; |
| |
| fp.lnum = lnum; |
| fp.col = (colnr_T)(s - line); |
| getvcol(curwin, &fp, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| return (int)col; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize a preprocessor statement: Any line that starts with '#'. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_ispreproc(s) |
| char_u *s; |
| { |
| if (*skipwhite(s) == '#') |
| return TRUE; |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE if line "*pp" at "*lnump" is a preprocessor statement or a |
| * continuation line of a preprocessor statement. Decrease "*lnump" to the |
| * start and return the line in "*pp". |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_ispreproc_cont(pp, lnump) |
| char_u **pp; |
| linenr_T *lnump; |
| { |
| char_u *line = *pp; |
| linenr_T lnum = *lnump; |
| int retval = FALSE; |
| |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| if (cin_ispreproc(line)) |
| { |
| retval = TRUE; |
| *lnump = lnum; |
| break; |
| } |
| if (lnum == 1) |
| break; |
| line = ml_get(--lnum); |
| if (*line == NUL || line[STRLEN(line) - 1] != '\\') |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (lnum != *lnump) |
| *pp = ml_get(*lnump); |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize the start of a C or C++ comment. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_iscomment(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| return (p[0] == '/' && (p[1] == '*' || p[1] == '/')); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize the start of a "//" comment. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_islinecomment(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| return (p[0] == '/' && p[1] == '/'); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize a line that starts with '{' or '}', or ends with ';', ',', '{' or |
| * '}'. |
| * Don't consider "} else" a terminated line. |
| * If a line begins with an "else", only consider it terminated if no unmatched |
| * opening braces follow (handle "else { foo();" correctly). |
| * Return the character terminating the line (ending char's have precedence if |
| * both apply in order to determine initializations). |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_isterminated(s, incl_open, incl_comma) |
| char_u *s; |
| int incl_open; /* include '{' at the end as terminator */ |
| int incl_comma; /* recognize a trailing comma */ |
| { |
| char_u found_start = 0; |
| unsigned n_open = 0; |
| int is_else = FALSE; |
| |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| |
| if (*s == '{' || (*s == '}' && !cin_iselse(s))) |
| found_start = *s; |
| |
| if (!found_start) |
| is_else = cin_iselse(s); |
| |
| while (*s) |
| { |
| /* skip over comments, "" strings and 'c'haracters */ |
| s = skip_string(cin_skipcomment(s)); |
| if (*s == '}' && n_open > 0) |
| --n_open; |
| if ((!is_else || n_open == 0) |
| && (*s == ';' || *s == '}' || (incl_comma && *s == ',')) |
| && cin_nocode(s + 1)) |
| return *s; |
| else if (*s == '{') |
| { |
| if (incl_open && cin_nocode(s + 1)) |
| return *s; |
| else |
| ++n_open; |
| } |
| |
| if (*s) |
| s++; |
| } |
| return found_start; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recognize the basic picture of a function declaration -- it needs to |
| * have an open paren somewhere and a close paren at the end of the line and |
| * no semicolons anywhere. |
| * When a line ends in a comma we continue looking in the next line. |
| * "sp" points to a string with the line. When looking at other lines it must |
| * be restored to the line. When it's NULL fetch lines here. |
| * "lnum" is where we start looking. |
| * "min_lnum" is the line before which we will not be looking. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_isfuncdecl(sp, first_lnum, min_lnum, ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment) |
| char_u **sp; |
| linenr_T first_lnum; |
| linenr_T min_lnum; |
| int ind_maxparen; |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| { |
| char_u *s; |
| linenr_T lnum = first_lnum; |
| int retval = FALSE; |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| int just_started = TRUE; |
| |
| if (sp == NULL) |
| s = ml_get(lnum); |
| else |
| s = *sp; |
| |
| if (find_last_paren(s, '(', ')') |
| && (trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| { |
| lnum = trypos->lnum; |
| if (lnum < min_lnum) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| s = ml_get(lnum); |
| } |
| |
| /* Ignore line starting with #. */ |
| if (cin_ispreproc(s)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| while (*s && *s != '(' && *s != ';' && *s != '\'' && *s != '"') |
| { |
| if (cin_iscomment(s)) /* ignore comments */ |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| else |
| ++s; |
| } |
| if (*s != '(') |
| return FALSE; /* ';', ' or " before any () or no '(' */ |
| |
| while (*s && *s != ';' && *s != '\'' && *s != '"') |
| { |
| if (*s == ')' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) |
| { |
| /* ')' at the end: may have found a match |
| * Check for he previous line not to end in a backslash: |
| * #if defined(x) && \ |
| * defined(y) |
| */ |
| lnum = first_lnum - 1; |
| s = ml_get(lnum); |
| if (*s == NUL || s[STRLEN(s) - 1] != '\\') |
| retval = TRUE; |
| goto done; |
| } |
| if ((*s == ',' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) || s[1] == NUL || cin_nocode(s)) |
| { |
| int comma = (*s == ','); |
| |
| /* ',' at the end: continue looking in the next line. |
| * At the end: check for ',' in the next line, for this style: |
| * func(arg1 |
| * , arg2) */ |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| if (lnum >= curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) |
| break; |
| s = ml_get(++lnum); |
| if (!cin_ispreproc(s)) |
| break; |
| } |
| if (lnum >= curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count) |
| break; |
| /* Require a comma at end of the line or a comma or ')' at the |
| * start of next line. */ |
| s = skipwhite(s); |
| if (!just_started && (!comma && *s != ',' && *s != ')')) |
| break; |
| just_started = FALSE; |
| } |
| else if (cin_iscomment(s)) /* ignore comments */ |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| else |
| { |
| ++s; |
| just_started = FALSE; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| done: |
| if (lnum != first_lnum && sp != NULL) |
| *sp = ml_get(first_lnum); |
| |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| cin_isif(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| return (STRNCMP(p, "if", 2) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[2])); |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| cin_iselse(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| if (*p == '}') /* accept "} else" */ |
| p = cin_skipcomment(p + 1); |
| return (STRNCMP(p, "else", 4) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[4])); |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| cin_isdo(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| return (STRNCMP(p, "do", 2) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[2])); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check if this is a "while" that should have a matching "do". |
| * We only accept a "while (condition) ;", with only white space between the |
| * ')' and ';'. The condition may be spread over several lines. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_iswhileofdo(p, lnum, ind_maxparen) /* XXX */ |
| char_u *p; |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| int ind_maxparen; |
| { |
| pos_T cursor_save; |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| int retval = FALSE; |
| |
| p = cin_skipcomment(p); |
| if (*p == '}') /* accept "} while (cond);" */ |
| p = cin_skipcomment(p + 1); |
| if (STRNCMP(p, "while", 5) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[5])) |
| { |
| cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| p = ml_get_curline(); |
| while (*p && *p != 'w') /* skip any '}', until the 'w' of the "while" */ |
| { |
| ++p; |
| ++curwin->w_cursor.col; |
| } |
| if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, 0, 0, ind_maxparen)) != NULL |
| && *cin_skipcomment(ml_get_pos(trypos) + 1) == ';') |
| retval = TRUE; |
| curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; |
| } |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check whether in "p" there is an "if", "for" or "while" before "*poffset". |
| * Return 0 if there is none. |
| * Otherwise return !0 and update "*poffset" to point to the place where the |
| * string was found. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset(line, poffset) |
| char_u *line; |
| int *poffset; |
| { |
| int offset = *poffset; |
| |
| if (offset-- < 2) |
| return 0; |
| while (offset > 2 && vim_iswhite(line[offset])) |
| --offset; |
| |
| offset -= 1; |
| if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "if", 2)) |
| goto probablyFound; |
| |
| if (offset >= 1) |
| { |
| offset -= 1; |
| if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "for", 3)) |
| goto probablyFound; |
| |
| if (offset >= 2) |
| { |
| offset -= 2; |
| if (!STRNCMP(line + offset, "while", 5)) |
| goto probablyFound; |
| } |
| } |
| return 0; |
| |
| probablyFound: |
| if (!offset || !vim_isIDc(line[offset - 1])) |
| { |
| *poffset = offset; |
| return 1; |
| } |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE if we are at the end of a do-while. |
| * do |
| * nothing; |
| * while (foo |
| * && bar); <-- here |
| * Adjust the cursor to the line with "while". |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_iswhileofdo_end(terminated, ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment) |
| int terminated; |
| int ind_maxparen; |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| { |
| char_u *line; |
| char_u *p; |
| char_u *s; |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| int i; |
| |
| if (terminated != ';') /* there must be a ';' at the end */ |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| p = line = ml_get_curline(); |
| while (*p != NUL) |
| { |
| p = cin_skipcomment(p); |
| if (*p == ')') |
| { |
| s = skipwhite(p + 1); |
| if (*s == ';' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) |
| { |
| /* Found ");" at end of the line, now check there is "while" |
| * before the matching '('. XXX */ |
| i = (int)(p - line); |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = i; |
| trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment); |
| if (trypos != NULL) |
| { |
| s = cin_skipcomment(ml_get(trypos->lnum)); |
| if (*s == '}') /* accept "} while (cond);" */ |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1); |
| if (STRNCMP(s, "while", 5) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[5])) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum; |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Searching may have made "line" invalid, get it again. */ |
| line = ml_get_curline(); |
| p = line + i; |
| } |
| } |
| if (*p != NUL) |
| ++p; |
| } |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| cin_isbreak(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| return (STRNCMP(p, "break", 5) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(p[5])); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Find the position of a C++ base-class declaration or |
| * constructor-initialization. eg: |
| * |
| * class MyClass : |
| * baseClass <-- here |
| * class MyClass : public baseClass, |
| * anotherBaseClass <-- here (should probably lineup ??) |
| * MyClass::MyClass(...) : |
| * baseClass(...) <-- here (constructor-initialization) |
| * |
| * This is a lot of guessing. Watch out for "cond ? func() : foo". |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_is_cpp_baseclass(col) |
| colnr_T *col; /* return: column to align with */ |
| { |
| char_u *s; |
| int class_or_struct, lookfor_ctor_init, cpp_base_class; |
| linenr_T lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| char_u *line = ml_get_curline(); |
| |
| *col = 0; |
| |
| s = skipwhite(line); |
| if (*s == '#') /* skip #define FOO x ? (x) : x */ |
| return FALSE; |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| if (*s == NUL) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| cpp_base_class = lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE; |
| |
| /* Search for a line starting with '#', empty, ending in ';' or containing |
| * '{' or '}' and start below it. This handles the following situations: |
| * a = cond ? |
| * func() : |
| * asdf; |
| * func::foo() |
| * : something |
| * {} |
| * Foo::Foo (int one, int two) |
| * : something(4), |
| * somethingelse(3) |
| * {} |
| */ |
| while (lnum > 1) |
| { |
| line = ml_get(lnum - 1); |
| s = skipwhite(line); |
| if (*s == '#' || *s == NUL) |
| break; |
| while (*s != NUL) |
| { |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s); |
| if (*s == '{' || *s == '}' |
| || (*s == ';' && cin_nocode(s + 1))) |
| break; |
| if (*s != NUL) |
| ++s; |
| } |
| if (*s != NUL) |
| break; |
| --lnum; |
| } |
| |
| line = ml_get(lnum); |
| s = cin_skipcomment(line); |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| if (*s == NUL) |
| { |
| if (lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum) |
| break; |
| /* Continue in the cursor line. */ |
| line = ml_get(++lnum); |
| s = cin_skipcomment(line); |
| if (*s == NUL) |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| if (s[0] == '"') |
| s = skip_string(s) + 1; |
| else if (s[0] == ':') |
| { |
| if (s[1] == ':') |
| { |
| /* skip double colon. It can't be a constructor |
| * initialization any more */ |
| lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE; |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 2); |
| } |
| else if (lookfor_ctor_init || class_or_struct) |
| { |
| /* we have something found, that looks like the start of |
| * cpp-base-class-declaration or constructor-initialization */ |
| cpp_base_class = TRUE; |
| lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE; |
| *col = 0; |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1); |
| } |
| else |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1); |
| } |
| else if ((STRNCMP(s, "class", 5) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[5])) |
| || (STRNCMP(s, "struct", 6) == 0 && !vim_isIDc(s[6]))) |
| { |
| class_or_struct = TRUE; |
| lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE; |
| |
| if (*s == 'c') |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 5); |
| else |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 6); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (s[0] == '{' || s[0] == '}' || s[0] == ';') |
| { |
| cpp_base_class = lookfor_ctor_init = class_or_struct = FALSE; |
| } |
| else if (s[0] == ')') |
| { |
| /* Constructor-initialization is assumed if we come across |
| * something like "):" */ |
| class_or_struct = FALSE; |
| lookfor_ctor_init = TRUE; |
| } |
| else if (s[0] == '?') |
| { |
| /* Avoid seeing '() :' after '?' as constructor init. */ |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| else if (!vim_isIDc(s[0])) |
| { |
| /* if it is not an identifier, we are wrong */ |
| class_or_struct = FALSE; |
| lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE; |
| } |
| else if (*col == 0) |
| { |
| /* it can't be a constructor-initialization any more */ |
| lookfor_ctor_init = FALSE; |
| |
| /* the first statement starts here: lineup with this one... */ |
| if (cpp_base_class) |
| *col = (colnr_T)(s - line); |
| } |
| |
| /* When the line ends in a comma don't align with it. */ |
| if (lnum == curwin->w_cursor.lnum && *s == ',' && cin_nocode(s + 1)) |
| *col = 0; |
| |
| s = cin_skipcomment(s + 1); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return cpp_base_class; |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| get_baseclass_amount(col, ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment, ind_cpp_baseclass) |
| int col; |
| int ind_maxparen; |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| int ind_cpp_baseclass; |
| { |
| int amount; |
| colnr_T vcol; |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| |
| if (col == 0) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent(); |
| if (find_last_paren(ml_get_curline(), '(', ')') |
| && (trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| amount = get_indent_lnum(trypos->lnum); /* XXX */ |
| if (!cin_ends_in(ml_get_curline(), (char_u *)",", NULL)) |
| amount += ind_cpp_baseclass; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = col; |
| getvcol(curwin, &curwin->w_cursor, &vcol, NULL, NULL); |
| amount = (int)vcol; |
| } |
| if (amount < ind_cpp_baseclass) |
| amount = ind_cpp_baseclass; |
| return amount; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE if string "s" ends with the string "find", possibly followed by |
| * white space and comments. Skip strings and comments. |
| * Ignore "ignore" after "find" if it's not NULL. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_ends_in(s, find, ignore) |
| char_u *s; |
| char_u *find; |
| char_u *ignore; |
| { |
| char_u *p = s; |
| char_u *r; |
| int len = (int)STRLEN(find); |
| |
| while (*p != NUL) |
| { |
| p = cin_skipcomment(p); |
| if (STRNCMP(p, find, len) == 0) |
| { |
| r = skipwhite(p + len); |
| if (ignore != NULL && STRNCMP(r, ignore, STRLEN(ignore)) == 0) |
| r = skipwhite(r + STRLEN(ignore)); |
| if (cin_nocode(r)) |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| if (*p != NUL) |
| ++p; |
| } |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Skip strings, chars and comments until at or past "trypos". |
| * Return the column found. |
| */ |
| static int |
| cin_skip2pos(trypos) |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| { |
| char_u *line; |
| char_u *p; |
| |
| p = line = ml_get(trypos->lnum); |
| while (*p && (colnr_T)(p - line) < trypos->col) |
| { |
| if (cin_iscomment(p)) |
| p = cin_skipcomment(p); |
| else |
| { |
| p = skip_string(p); |
| ++p; |
| } |
| } |
| return (int)(p - line); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Find the '{' at the start of the block we are in. |
| * Return NULL if no match found. |
| * Ignore a '{' that is in a comment, makes indenting the next three lines |
| * work. */ |
| /* foo() */ |
| /* { */ |
| /* } */ |
| |
| static pos_T * |
| find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment) /* XXX */ |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| { |
| pos_T cursor_save; |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| pos_T *pos; |
| static pos_T pos_copy; |
| |
| cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; |
| while ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, '{', FM_BLOCKSTOP, 0)) != NULL) |
| { |
| pos_copy = *trypos; /* copy pos_T, next findmatch will change it */ |
| trypos = &pos_copy; |
| curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; |
| pos = NULL; |
| /* ignore the { if it's in a // or / * * / comment */ |
| if ((colnr_T)cin_skip2pos(trypos) == trypos->col |
| && (pos = find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment)) == NULL) /* XXX */ |
| break; |
| if (pos != NULL) |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; |
| } |
| curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; |
| return trypos; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Find the matching '(', failing if it is in a comment. |
| * Return NULL if no match found. |
| */ |
| static pos_T * |
| find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment) /* XXX */ |
| int ind_maxparen; |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| { |
| pos_T cursor_save; |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| static pos_T pos_copy; |
| |
| cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; |
| if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, '(', 0, ind_maxparen)) != NULL) |
| { |
| /* check if the ( is in a // comment */ |
| if ((colnr_T)cin_skip2pos(trypos) > trypos->col) |
| trypos = NULL; |
| else |
| { |
| pos_copy = *trypos; /* copy trypos, findmatch will change it */ |
| trypos = &pos_copy; |
| curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; |
| if (find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment) != NULL) /* XXX */ |
| trypos = NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; |
| return trypos; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return ind_maxparen corrected for the difference in line number between the |
| * cursor position and "startpos". This makes sure that searching for a |
| * matching paren above the cursor line doesn't find a match because of |
| * looking a few lines further. |
| */ |
| static int |
| corr_ind_maxparen(ind_maxparen, startpos) |
| int ind_maxparen; |
| pos_T *startpos; |
| { |
| long n = (long)startpos->lnum - (long)curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| |
| if (n > 0 && n < ind_maxparen / 2) |
| return ind_maxparen - (int)n; |
| return ind_maxparen; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Set w_cursor.col to the column number of the last unmatched ')' or '{' in |
| * line "l". "l" must point to the start of the line. |
| */ |
| static int |
| find_last_paren(l, start, end) |
| char_u *l; |
| int start, end; |
| { |
| int i; |
| int retval = FALSE; |
| int open_count = 0; |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; /* default is start of line */ |
| |
| for (i = 0; l[i] != NUL; i++) |
| { |
| i = (int)(cin_skipcomment(l + i) - l); /* ignore parens in comments */ |
| i = (int)(skip_string(l + i) - l); /* ignore parens in quotes */ |
| if (l[i] == start) |
| ++open_count; |
| else if (l[i] == end) |
| { |
| if (open_count > 0) |
| --open_count; |
| else |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = i; |
| retval = TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| get_c_indent() |
| { |
| int sw = (int)get_sw_value(); |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from a block's opening brace the prevailing indent for that |
| * block should be |
| */ |
| |
| int ind_level = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the edge of the line an open brace that's at the end of a |
| * line is imagined to be. |
| */ |
| int ind_open_imag = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the prevailing indent for a line that is not preceded by |
| * an opening brace. |
| */ |
| int ind_no_brace = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * column where the first { of a function should be located } |
| */ |
| int ind_first_open = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the prevailing indent a leftmost open brace should be |
| * located |
| */ |
| int ind_open_extra = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the matching open brace (real location for one at the left |
| * edge; imaginary location from one that ends a line) the matching close |
| * brace should be located |
| */ |
| int ind_close_extra = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the edge of the line an open brace sitting in the leftmost |
| * column is imagined to be |
| */ |
| int ind_open_left_imag = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Spaces jump labels should be shifted to the left if N is non-negative, |
| * otherwise the jump label will be put to column 1. |
| */ |
| int ind_jump_label = -1; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the switch() indent a "case xx" label should be located |
| */ |
| int ind_case = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the "case xx:" code after a switch() should be located |
| */ |
| int ind_case_code = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * lineup break at end of case in switch() with case label |
| */ |
| int ind_case_break = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the class declaration indent a scope declaration label |
| * should be located |
| */ |
| int ind_scopedecl = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the scope declaration label code should be located |
| */ |
| int ind_scopedecl_code = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * amount K&R-style parameters should be indented |
| */ |
| int ind_param = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * amount a function type spec should be indented |
| */ |
| int ind_func_type = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * amount a cpp base class declaration or constructor initialization |
| * should be indented |
| */ |
| int ind_cpp_baseclass = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * additional spaces beyond the prevailing indent a continuation line |
| * should be located |
| */ |
| int ind_continuation = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the indent of the line with an unclosed parentheses |
| */ |
| int ind_unclosed = sw * 2; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the indent of the line with an unclosed parentheses, which |
| * itself is also unclosed |
| */ |
| int ind_unclosed2 = sw; |
| |
| /* |
| * suppress ignoring spaces from the indent of a line starting with an |
| * unclosed parentheses. |
| */ |
| int ind_unclosed_noignore = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * If the opening paren is the last nonwhite character on the line, and |
| * ind_unclosed_wrapped is nonzero, use this indent relative to the outer |
| * context (for very long lines). |
| */ |
| int ind_unclosed_wrapped = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * suppress ignoring white space when lining up with the character after |
| * an unclosed parentheses. |
| */ |
| int ind_unclosed_whiteok = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * indent a closing parentheses under the line start of the matching |
| * opening parentheses. |
| */ |
| int ind_matching_paren = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * indent a closing parentheses under the previous line. |
| */ |
| int ind_paren_prev = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Extra indent for comments. |
| */ |
| int ind_comment = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * spaces from the comment opener when there is nothing after it. |
| */ |
| int ind_in_comment = 3; |
| |
| /* |
| * boolean: if non-zero, use ind_in_comment even if there is something |
| * after the comment opener. |
| */ |
| int ind_in_comment2 = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * max lines to search for an open paren |
| */ |
| int ind_maxparen = 20; |
| |
| /* |
| * max lines to search for an open comment |
| */ |
| int ind_maxcomment = 70; |
| |
| /* |
| * handle braces for java code |
| */ |
| int ind_java = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * not to confuse JS object properties with labels |
| */ |
| int ind_js = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * handle blocked cases correctly |
| */ |
| int ind_keep_case_label = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * handle C++ namespace |
| */ |
| int ind_cpp_namespace = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * handle continuation lines containing conditions of if(), for() and |
| * while() |
| */ |
| int ind_if_for_while = 0; |
| |
| pos_T cur_curpos; |
| int amount; |
| int scope_amount; |
| int cur_amount = MAXCOL; |
| colnr_T col; |
| char_u *theline; |
| char_u *linecopy; |
| pos_T *trypos; |
| pos_T *tryposBrace = NULL; |
| pos_T our_paren_pos; |
| char_u *start; |
| int start_brace; |
| #define BRACE_IN_COL0 1 /* '{' is in column 0 */ |
| #define BRACE_AT_START 2 /* '{' is at start of line */ |
| #define BRACE_AT_END 3 /* '{' is at end of line */ |
| linenr_T ourscope; |
| char_u *l; |
| char_u *look; |
| char_u terminated; |
| int lookfor; |
| #define LOOKFOR_INITIAL 0 |
| #define LOOKFOR_IF 1 |
| #define LOOKFOR_DO 2 |
| #define LOOKFOR_CASE 3 |
| #define LOOKFOR_ANY 4 |
| #define LOOKFOR_TERM 5 |
| #define LOOKFOR_UNTERM 6 |
| #define LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL 7 |
| #define LOOKFOR_NOBREAK 8 |
| #define LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS 9 |
| #define LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT 10 |
| |
| int whilelevel; |
| linenr_T lnum; |
| char_u *options; |
| char_u *digits; |
| int fraction = 0; /* init for GCC */ |
| int divider; |
| int n; |
| int iscase; |
| int lookfor_break; |
| int lookfor_cpp_namespace = FALSE; |
| int cont_amount = 0; /* amount for continuation line */ |
| int original_line_islabel; |
| int added_to_amount = 0; |
| |
| for (options = curbuf->b_p_cino; *options; ) |
| { |
| l = options++; |
| if (*options == '-') |
| ++options; |
| digits = options; /* remember where the digits start */ |
| n = getdigits(&options); |
| divider = 0; |
| if (*options == '.') /* ".5s" means a fraction */ |
| { |
| fraction = atol((char *)++options); |
| while (VIM_ISDIGIT(*options)) |
| { |
| ++options; |
| if (divider) |
| divider *= 10; |
| else |
| divider = 10; |
| } |
| } |
| if (*options == 's') /* "2s" means two times 'shiftwidth' */ |
| { |
| if (options == digits) |
| n = sw; /* just "s" is one 'shiftwidth' */ |
| else |
| { |
| n *= sw; |
| if (divider) |
| n += (sw * fraction + divider / 2) / divider; |
| } |
| ++options; |
| } |
| if (l[1] == '-') |
| n = -n; |
| /* When adding an entry here, also update the default 'cinoptions' in |
| * doc/indent.txt, and add explanation for it! */ |
| switch (*l) |
| { |
| case '>': ind_level = n; break; |
| case 'e': ind_open_imag = n; break; |
| case 'n': ind_no_brace = n; break; |
| case 'f': ind_first_open = n; break; |
| case '{': ind_open_extra = n; break; |
| case '}': ind_close_extra = n; break; |
| case '^': ind_open_left_imag = n; break; |
| case 'L': ind_jump_label = n; break; |
| case ':': ind_case = n; break; |
| case '=': ind_case_code = n; break; |
| case 'b': ind_case_break = n; break; |
| case 'p': ind_param = n; break; |
| case 't': ind_func_type = n; break; |
| case '/': ind_comment = n; break; |
| case 'c': ind_in_comment = n; break; |
| case 'C': ind_in_comment2 = n; break; |
| case 'i': ind_cpp_baseclass = n; break; |
| case '+': ind_continuation = n; break; |
| case '(': ind_unclosed = n; break; |
| case 'u': ind_unclosed2 = n; break; |
| case 'U': ind_unclosed_noignore = n; break; |
| case 'W': ind_unclosed_wrapped = n; break; |
| case 'w': ind_unclosed_whiteok = n; break; |
| case 'm': ind_matching_paren = n; break; |
| case 'M': ind_paren_prev = n; break; |
| case ')': ind_maxparen = n; break; |
| case '*': ind_maxcomment = n; break; |
| case 'g': ind_scopedecl = n; break; |
| case 'h': ind_scopedecl_code = n; break; |
| case 'j': ind_java = n; break; |
| case 'J': ind_js = n; break; |
| case 'l': ind_keep_case_label = n; break; |
| case '#': ind_hash_comment = n; break; |
| case 'N': ind_cpp_namespace = n; break; |
| case 'k': ind_if_for_while = n; break; |
| } |
| if (*options == ',') |
| ++options; |
| } |
| |
| /* remember where the cursor was when we started */ |
| cur_curpos = curwin->w_cursor; |
| |
| /* if we are at line 1 0 is fine, right? */ |
| if (cur_curpos.lnum == 1) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* Get a copy of the current contents of the line. |
| * This is required, because only the most recent line obtained with |
| * ml_get is valid! */ |
| linecopy = vim_strsave(ml_get(cur_curpos.lnum)); |
| if (linecopy == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * In insert mode and the cursor is on a ')' truncate the line at the |
| * cursor position. We don't want to line up with the matching '(' when |
| * inserting new stuff. |
| * For unknown reasons the cursor might be past the end of the line, thus |
| * check for that. |
| */ |
| if ((State & INSERT) |
| && curwin->w_cursor.col < (colnr_T)STRLEN(linecopy) |
| && linecopy[curwin->w_cursor.col] == ')') |
| linecopy[curwin->w_cursor.col] = NUL; |
| |
| theline = skipwhite(linecopy); |
| |
| /* move the cursor to the start of the line */ |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| |
| original_line_islabel = cin_islabel(ind_maxcomment); /* XXX */ |
| |
| /* |
| * #defines and so on always go at the left when included in 'cinkeys'. |
| */ |
| if (*theline == '#' && (*linecopy == '#' || in_cinkeys('#', ' ', TRUE))) |
| { |
| amount = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Is it a non-case label? Then that goes at the left margin too unless: |
| * - JS flag is set. |
| * - 'L' item has a positive value. |
| */ |
| else if (original_line_islabel && !ind_js && ind_jump_label < 0) |
| { |
| amount = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're inside a "//" comment and there is a "//" comment in a |
| * previous line, lineup with that one. |
| */ |
| else if (cin_islinecomment(theline) |
| && (trypos = find_line_comment()) != NULL) /* XXX */ |
| { |
| /* find how indented the line beginning the comment is */ |
| getvcol(curwin, trypos, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| amount = col; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're inside a comment and not looking at the start of the |
| * comment, try using the 'comments' option. |
| */ |
| else if (!cin_iscomment(theline) |
| && (trypos = find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) /* XXX */ |
| { |
| int lead_start_len = 2; |
| int lead_middle_len = 1; |
| char_u lead_start[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* start-comment string */ |
| char_u lead_middle[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* middle-comment string */ |
| char_u lead_end[COM_MAX_LEN]; /* end-comment string */ |
| char_u *p; |
| int start_align = 0; |
| int start_off = 0; |
| int done = FALSE; |
| |
| /* find how indented the line beginning the comment is */ |
| getvcol(curwin, trypos, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| amount = col; |
| *lead_start = NUL; |
| *lead_middle = NUL; |
| |
| p = curbuf->b_p_com; |
| while (*p != NUL) |
| { |
| int align = 0; |
| int off = 0; |
| int what = 0; |
| |
| while (*p != NUL && *p != ':') |
| { |
| if (*p == COM_START || *p == COM_END || *p == COM_MIDDLE) |
| what = *p++; |
| else if (*p == COM_LEFT || *p == COM_RIGHT) |
| align = *p++; |
| else if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p) || *p == '-') |
| off = getdigits(&p); |
| else |
| ++p; |
| } |
| |
| if (*p == ':') |
| ++p; |
| (void)copy_option_part(&p, lead_end, COM_MAX_LEN, ","); |
| if (what == COM_START) |
| { |
| STRCPY(lead_start, lead_end); |
| lead_start_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_start); |
| start_off = off; |
| start_align = align; |
| } |
| else if (what == COM_MIDDLE) |
| { |
| STRCPY(lead_middle, lead_end); |
| lead_middle_len = (int)STRLEN(lead_middle); |
| } |
| else if (what == COM_END) |
| { |
| /* If our line starts with the middle comment string, line it |
| * up with the comment opener per the 'comments' option. */ |
| if (STRNCMP(theline, lead_middle, lead_middle_len) == 0 |
| && STRNCMP(theline, lead_end, STRLEN(lead_end)) != 0) |
| { |
| done = TRUE; |
| if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) |
| { |
| /* If the start comment string matches in the previous |
| * line, use the indent of that line plus offset. If |
| * the middle comment string matches in the previous |
| * line, use the indent of that line. XXX */ |
| look = skipwhite(ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1)); |
| if (STRNCMP(look, lead_start, lead_start_len) == 0) |
| amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); |
| else if (STRNCMP(look, lead_middle, |
| lead_middle_len) == 0) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); |
| break; |
| } |
| /* If the start comment string doesn't match with the |
| * start of the comment, skip this entry. XXX */ |
| else if (STRNCMP(ml_get(trypos->lnum) + trypos->col, |
| lead_start, lead_start_len) != 0) |
| continue; |
| } |
| if (start_off != 0) |
| amount += start_off; |
| else if (start_align == COM_RIGHT) |
| amount += vim_strsize(lead_start) |
| - vim_strsize(lead_middle); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* If our line starts with the end comment string, line it up |
| * with the middle comment */ |
| if (STRNCMP(theline, lead_middle, lead_middle_len) != 0 |
| && STRNCMP(theline, lead_end, STRLEN(lead_end)) == 0) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); |
| /* XXX */ |
| if (off != 0) |
| amount += off; |
| else if (align == COM_RIGHT) |
| amount += vim_strsize(lead_start) |
| - vim_strsize(lead_middle); |
| done = TRUE; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* If our line starts with an asterisk, line up with the |
| * asterisk in the comment opener; otherwise, line up |
| * with the first character of the comment text. |
| */ |
| if (done) |
| ; |
| else if (theline[0] == '*') |
| amount += 1; |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * If we are more than one line away from the comment opener, take |
| * the indent of the previous non-empty line. If 'cino' has "CO" |
| * and we are just below the comment opener and there are any |
| * white characters after it line up with the text after it; |
| * otherwise, add the amount specified by "c" in 'cino' |
| */ |
| amount = -1; |
| for (lnum = cur_curpos.lnum - 1; lnum > trypos->lnum; --lnum) |
| { |
| if (linewhite(lnum)) /* skip blank lines */ |
| continue; |
| amount = get_indent_lnum(lnum); /* XXX */ |
| break; |
| } |
| if (amount == -1) /* use the comment opener */ |
| { |
| if (!ind_in_comment2) |
| { |
| start = ml_get(trypos->lnum); |
| look = start + trypos->col + 2; /* skip / and * */ |
| if (*look != NUL) /* if something after it */ |
| trypos->col = (colnr_T)(skipwhite(look) - start); |
| } |
| getvcol(curwin, trypos, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| amount = col; |
| if (ind_in_comment2 || *look == NUL) |
| amount += ind_in_comment; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Are we inside parentheses or braces? |
| */ /* XXX */ |
| else if (((trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment)) != NULL |
| && ind_java == 0) |
| || (tryposBrace = find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment)) != NULL |
| || trypos != NULL) |
| { |
| if (trypos != NULL && tryposBrace != NULL) |
| { |
| /* Both an unmatched '(' and '{' is found. Use the one which is |
| * closer to the current cursor position, set the other to NULL. */ |
| if (trypos->lnum != tryposBrace->lnum |
| ? trypos->lnum < tryposBrace->lnum |
| : trypos->col < tryposBrace->col) |
| trypos = NULL; |
| else |
| tryposBrace = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| if (trypos != NULL) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If the matching paren is more than one line away, use the indent of |
| * a previous non-empty line that matches the same paren. |
| */ |
| if (theline[0] == ')' && ind_paren_prev) |
| { |
| /* Line up with the start of the matching paren line. */ |
| amount = get_indent_lnum(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); /* XXX */ |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| amount = -1; |
| our_paren_pos = *trypos; |
| for (lnum = cur_curpos.lnum - 1; lnum > our_paren_pos.lnum; --lnum) |
| { |
| l = skipwhite(ml_get(lnum)); |
| if (cin_nocode(l)) /* skip comment lines */ |
| continue; |
| if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &lnum)) |
| continue; /* ignore #define, #if, etc. */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum; |
| |
| /* Skip a comment. XXX */ |
| if ((trypos = find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| { |
| lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* XXX */ |
| if ((trypos = find_match_paren( |
| corr_ind_maxparen(ind_maxparen, &cur_curpos), |
| ind_maxcomment)) != NULL |
| && trypos->lnum == our_paren_pos.lnum |
| && trypos->col == our_paren_pos.col) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent_lnum(lnum); /* XXX */ |
| |
| if (theline[0] == ')') |
| { |
| if (our_paren_pos.lnum != lnum |
| && cur_amount > amount) |
| cur_amount = amount; |
| amount = -1; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Line up with line where the matching paren is. XXX |
| * If the line starts with a '(' or the indent for unclosed |
| * parentheses is zero, line up with the unclosed parentheses. |
| */ |
| if (amount == -1) |
| { |
| int ignore_paren_col = 0; |
| int is_if_for_while = 0; |
| |
| if (ind_if_for_while) |
| { |
| /* Look for the outermost opening parenthesis on this line |
| * and check whether it belongs to an "if", "for" or "while". */ |
| |
| pos_T cursor_save = curwin->w_cursor; |
| pos_T outermost; |
| char_u *line; |
| |
| trypos = &our_paren_pos; |
| do { |
| outermost = *trypos; |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = outermost.lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = outermost.col; |
| |
| trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment); |
| } while (trypos && trypos->lnum == outermost.lnum); |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor = cursor_save; |
| |
| line = ml_get(outermost.lnum); |
| |
| is_if_for_while = |
| cin_is_if_for_while_before_offset(line, &outermost.col); |
| } |
| |
| amount = skip_label(our_paren_pos.lnum, &look, ind_maxcomment); |
| look = skipwhite(look); |
| if (*look == '(') |
| { |
| linenr_T save_lnum = curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| char_u *line; |
| int look_col; |
| |
| /* Ignore a '(' in front of the line that has a match before |
| * our matching '('. */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = our_paren_pos.lnum; |
| line = ml_get_curline(); |
| look_col = (int)(look - line); |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = look_col + 1; |
| if ((trypos = findmatchlimit(NULL, ')', 0, ind_maxparen)) |
| != NULL |
| && trypos->lnum == our_paren_pos.lnum |
| && trypos->col < our_paren_pos.col) |
| ignore_paren_col = trypos->col + 1; |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = save_lnum; |
| look = ml_get(our_paren_pos.lnum) + look_col; |
| } |
| if (theline[0] == ')' || (ind_unclosed == 0 && is_if_for_while == 0) |
| || (!ind_unclosed_noignore && *look == '(' |
| && ignore_paren_col == 0)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If we're looking at a close paren, line up right there; |
| * otherwise, line up with the next (non-white) character. |
| * When ind_unclosed_wrapped is set and the matching paren is |
| * the last nonwhite character of the line, use either the |
| * indent of the current line or the indentation of the next |
| * outer paren and add ind_unclosed_wrapped (for very long |
| * lines). |
| */ |
| if (theline[0] != ')') |
| { |
| cur_amount = MAXCOL; |
| l = ml_get(our_paren_pos.lnum); |
| if (ind_unclosed_wrapped |
| && cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)"(", NULL)) |
| { |
| /* look for opening unmatched paren, indent one level |
| * for each additional level */ |
| n = 1; |
| for (col = 0; col < our_paren_pos.col; ++col) |
| { |
| switch (l[col]) |
| { |
| case '(': |
| case '{': ++n; |
| break; |
| |
| case ')': |
| case '}': if (n > 1) |
| --n; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| our_paren_pos.col = 0; |
| amount += n * ind_unclosed_wrapped; |
| } |
| else if (ind_unclosed_whiteok) |
| our_paren_pos.col++; |
| else |
| { |
| col = our_paren_pos.col + 1; |
| while (vim_iswhite(l[col])) |
| col++; |
| if (l[col] != NUL) /* In case of trailing space */ |
| our_paren_pos.col = col; |
| else |
| our_paren_pos.col++; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Find how indented the paren is, or the character after it |
| * if we did the above "if". |
| */ |
| if (our_paren_pos.col > 0) |
| { |
| getvcol(curwin, &our_paren_pos, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| if (cur_amount > (int)col) |
| cur_amount = col; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (theline[0] == ')' && ind_matching_paren) |
| { |
| /* Line up with the start of the matching paren line. */ |
| } |
| else if ((ind_unclosed == 0 && is_if_for_while == 0) |
| || (!ind_unclosed_noignore |
| && *look == '(' && ignore_paren_col == 0)) |
| { |
| if (cur_amount != MAXCOL) |
| amount = cur_amount; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Add ind_unclosed2 for each '(' before our matching one, but |
| * ignore (void) before the line (ignore_paren_col). */ |
| col = our_paren_pos.col; |
| while ((int)our_paren_pos.col > ignore_paren_col) |
| { |
| --our_paren_pos.col; |
| switch (*ml_get_pos(&our_paren_pos)) |
| { |
| case '(': amount += ind_unclosed2; |
| col = our_paren_pos.col; |
| break; |
| case ')': amount -= ind_unclosed2; |
| col = MAXCOL; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Use ind_unclosed once, when the first '(' is not inside |
| * braces */ |
| if (col == MAXCOL) |
| amount += ind_unclosed; |
| else |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = our_paren_pos.lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = col; |
| if (find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment) != NULL) |
| amount += ind_unclosed2; |
| else |
| { |
| if (is_if_for_while) |
| amount += ind_if_for_while; |
| else |
| amount += ind_unclosed; |
| } |
| } |
| /* |
| * For a line starting with ')' use the minimum of the two |
| * positions, to avoid giving it more indent than the previous |
| * lines: |
| * func_long_name( if (x |
| * arg && yy |
| * ) ^ not here ) ^ not here |
| */ |
| if (cur_amount < amount) |
| amount = cur_amount; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* add extra indent for a comment */ |
| if (cin_iscomment(theline)) |
| amount += ind_comment; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Are we at least inside braces, then? |
| */ |
| else |
| { |
| trypos = tryposBrace; |
| |
| ourscope = trypos->lnum; |
| start = ml_get(ourscope); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now figure out how indented the line is in general. |
| * If the brace was at the start of the line, we use that; |
| * otherwise, check out the indentation of the line as |
| * a whole and then add the "imaginary indent" to that. |
| */ |
| look = skipwhite(start); |
| if (*look == '{') |
| { |
| getvcol(curwin, trypos, &col, NULL, NULL); |
| amount = col; |
| if (*start == '{') |
| start_brace = BRACE_IN_COL0; |
| else |
| start_brace = BRACE_AT_START; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * that opening brace might have been on a continuation |
| * line. if so, find the start of the line. |
| */ |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = ourscope; |
| |
| /* |
| * position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that |
| * matching it will take us back to the start of the line. |
| */ |
| lnum = ourscope; |
| if (find_last_paren(start, '(', ')') |
| && (trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| lnum = trypos->lnum; |
| |
| /* |
| * It could have been something like |
| * case 1: if (asdf && |
| * ldfd) { |
| * } |
| */ |
| if (ind_js || (ind_keep_case_label |
| && cin_iscase(skipwhite(ml_get_curline()), FALSE))) |
| amount = get_indent(); |
| else |
| amount = skip_label(lnum, &l, ind_maxcomment); |
| |
| start_brace = BRACE_AT_END; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * if we're looking at a closing brace, that's where |
| * we want to be. otherwise, add the amount of room |
| * that an indent is supposed to be. |
| */ |
| if (theline[0] == '}') |
| { |
| /* |
| * they may want closing braces to line up with something |
| * other than the open brace. indulge them, if so. |
| */ |
| amount += ind_close_extra; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * If we're looking at an "else", try to find an "if" |
| * to match it with. |
| * If we're looking at a "while", try to find a "do" |
| * to match it with. |
| */ |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_INITIAL; |
| if (cin_iselse(theline)) |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_IF; |
| else if (cin_iswhileofdo(theline, cur_curpos.lnum, ind_maxparen)) |
| /* XXX */ |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_DO; |
| if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_INITIAL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = cur_curpos.lnum; |
| if (find_match(lookfor, ourscope, ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment) == OK) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ |
| goto theend; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * We get here if we are not on an "while-of-do" or "else" (or |
| * failed to find a matching "if"). |
| * Search backwards for something to line up with. |
| * First set amount for when we don't find anything. |
| */ |
| |
| /* |
| * if the '{' is _really_ at the left margin, use the imaginary |
| * location of a left-margin brace. Otherwise, correct the |
| * location for ind_open_extra. |
| */ |
| |
| if (start_brace == BRACE_IN_COL0) /* '{' is in column 0 */ |
| { |
| amount = ind_open_left_imag; |
| lookfor_cpp_namespace = TRUE; |
| } |
| else if (start_brace == BRACE_AT_START && |
| lookfor_cpp_namespace) /* '{' is at start */ |
| { |
| |
| lookfor_cpp_namespace = TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (start_brace == BRACE_AT_END) /* '{' is at end of line */ |
| { |
| amount += ind_open_imag; |
| |
| l = skipwhite(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (cin_is_cpp_namespace(l)) |
| amount += ind_cpp_namespace; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Compensate for adding ind_open_extra later. */ |
| amount -= ind_open_extra; |
| if (amount < 0) |
| amount = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| lookfor_break = FALSE; |
| |
| if (cin_iscase(theline, FALSE)) /* it's a switch() label */ |
| { |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_CASE; /* find a previous switch() label */ |
| amount += ind_case; |
| } |
| else if (cin_isscopedecl(theline)) /* private:, ... */ |
| { |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL; /* class decl is this block */ |
| amount += ind_scopedecl; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (ind_case_break && cin_isbreak(theline)) /* break; ... */ |
| lookfor_break = TRUE; |
| |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_INITIAL; |
| amount += ind_level; /* ind_level from start of block */ |
| } |
| scope_amount = amount; |
| whilelevel = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Search backwards. If we find something we recognize, line up |
| * with that. |
| * |
| * if we're looking at an open brace, indent |
| * the usual amount relative to the conditional |
| * that opens the block. |
| */ |
| curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos; |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum--; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * If we went all the way back to the start of our scope, line |
| * up with it. |
| */ |
| if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum <= ourscope) |
| { |
| /* we reached end of scope: |
| * if looking for a enum or structure initialization |
| * go further back: |
| * if it is an initializer (enum xxx or xxx =), then |
| * don't add ind_continuation, otherwise it is a variable |
| * declaration: |
| * int x, |
| * here; <-- add ind_continuation |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) |
| { |
| if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == 0 |
| || curwin->w_cursor.lnum |
| < ourscope - ind_maxparen) |
| { |
| /* nothing found (abuse ind_maxparen as limit) |
| * assume terminated line (i.e. a variable |
| * initialization) */ |
| if (cont_amount > 0) |
| amount = cont_amount; |
| else if (!ind_js) |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're in a comment now, skip to the start of the |
| * comment. |
| */ |
| trypos = find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment); |
| if (trypos != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines. |
| */ |
| if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (cin_nocode(l)) |
| continue; |
| |
| terminated = cin_isterminated(l, FALSE, TRUE); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we are at top level and the line looks like a |
| * function declaration, we are done |
| * (it's a variable declaration). |
| */ |
| if (start_brace != BRACE_IN_COL0 |
| || !cin_isfuncdecl(&l, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, |
| 0, ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment)) |
| { |
| /* if the line is terminated with another ',' |
| * it is a continued variable initialization. |
| * don't add extra indent. |
| * TODO: does not work, if a function |
| * declaration is split over multiple lines: |
| * cin_isfuncdecl returns FALSE then. |
| */ |
| if (terminated == ',') |
| break; |
| |
| /* if it es a enum declaration or an assignment, |
| * we are done. |
| */ |
| if (terminated != ';' && cin_isinit()) |
| break; |
| |
| /* nothing useful found */ |
| if (terminated == 0 || terminated == '{') |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| if (terminated != ';') |
| { |
| /* Skip parens and braces. Position the cursor |
| * over the rightmost paren, so that matching it |
| * will take us back to the start of the line. |
| */ /* XXX */ |
| trypos = NULL; |
| if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')')) |
| trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment); |
| |
| if (trypos == NULL && find_last_paren(l, '{', '}')) |
| trypos = find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment); |
| |
| if (trypos != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* it's a variable declaration, add indentation |
| * like in |
| * int a, |
| * b; |
| */ |
| if (cont_amount > 0) |
| amount = cont_amount; |
| else |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| } |
| else if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM) |
| { |
| if (cont_amount > 0) |
| amount = cont_amount; |
| else |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM |
| && lookfor != LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS) |
| { |
| amount = scope_amount; |
| if (theline[0] == '{') |
| { |
| amount += ind_open_extra; |
| added_to_amount = ind_open_extra; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (lookfor_cpp_namespace) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Looking for C++ namespace, need to look further |
| * back. |
| */ |
| if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == ourscope) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum == 0 |
| || curwin->w_cursor.lnum |
| < ourscope - FIND_NAMESPACE_LIM) |
| break; |
| |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| |
| /* If we're in a comment now, skip to the start of |
| * the comment. */ |
| trypos = find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment); |
| if (trypos != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines. */ |
| if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* Finally the actual check for "namespace". */ |
| if (cin_is_cpp_namespace(l)) |
| { |
| amount += ind_cpp_namespace - added_to_amount; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (cin_nocode(l)) |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're in a comment now, skip to the start of the comment. |
| */ /* XXX */ |
| if ((trypos = find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| |
| /* |
| * If this is a switch() label, may line up relative to that. |
| * If this is a C++ scope declaration, do the same. |
| */ |
| iscase = cin_iscase(l, FALSE); |
| if (iscase || cin_isscopedecl(l)) |
| { |
| /* we are only looking for cpp base class |
| * declaration/initialization any longer */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS) |
| break; |
| |
| /* When looking for a "do" we are not interested in |
| * labels. */ |
| if (whilelevel > 0) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* |
| * case xx: |
| * c = 99 + <- this indent plus continuation |
| *-> here; |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM |
| || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) |
| { |
| if (cont_amount > 0) |
| amount = cont_amount; |
| else |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * case xx: <- line up with this case |
| * x = 333; |
| * case yy: |
| */ |
| if ( (iscase && lookfor == LOOKFOR_CASE) |
| || (iscase && lookfor_break) |
| || (!iscase && lookfor == LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Check that this case label is not for another |
| * switch() |
| */ /* XXX */ |
| if ((trypos = find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment)) == |
| NULL || trypos->lnum == ourscope) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ |
| break; |
| } |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| n = get_indent_nolabel(curwin->w_cursor.lnum); /* XXX */ |
| |
| /* |
| * case xx: if (cond) <- line up with this if |
| * y = y + 1; |
| * -> s = 99; |
| * |
| * case xx: |
| * if (cond) <- line up with this line |
| * y = y + 1; |
| * -> s = 99; |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM) |
| { |
| if (n) |
| amount = n; |
| |
| if (!lookfor_break) |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * case xx: x = x + 1; <- line up with this x |
| * -> y = y + 1; |
| * |
| * case xx: if (cond) <- line up with this if |
| * -> y = y + 1; |
| */ |
| if (n) |
| { |
| amount = n; |
| l = after_label(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (l != NULL && cin_is_cinword(l)) |
| { |
| if (theline[0] == '{') |
| amount += ind_open_extra; |
| else |
| amount += ind_level + ind_no_brace; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Try to get the indent of a statement before the switch |
| * label. If nothing is found, line up relative to the |
| * switch label. |
| * break; <- may line up with this line |
| * case xx: |
| * -> y = 1; |
| */ |
| scope_amount = get_indent() + (iscase /* XXX */ |
| ? ind_case_code : ind_scopedecl_code); |
| lookfor = ind_case_break ? LOOKFOR_NOBREAK : LOOKFOR_ANY; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Looking for a switch() label or C++ scope declaration, |
| * ignore other lines, skip {}-blocks. |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CASE || lookfor == LOOKFOR_SCOPEDECL) |
| { |
| if (find_last_paren(l, '{', '}') && (trypos = |
| find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| } |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Ignore jump labels with nothing after them. |
| */ |
| if (!ind_js && cin_islabel(ind_maxcomment)) |
| { |
| l = after_label(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (l == NULL || cin_nocode(l)) |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Ignore #defines, #if, etc. |
| * Ignore comment and empty lines. |
| * (need to get the line again, cin_islabel() may have |
| * unlocked it) |
| */ |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum) |
| || cin_nocode(l)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* |
| * Are we at the start of a cpp base class declaration or |
| * constructor initialization? |
| */ /* XXX */ |
| n = FALSE; |
| if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM && ind_cpp_baseclass > 0) |
| { |
| n = cin_is_cpp_baseclass(&col); |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| } |
| if (n) |
| { |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM) |
| { |
| if (cont_amount > 0) |
| amount = cont_amount; |
| else |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| } |
| else if (theline[0] == '{') |
| { |
| /* Need to find start of the declaration. */ |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_UNTERM; |
| ind_continuation = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| else |
| /* XXX */ |
| amount = get_baseclass_amount(col, ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment, ind_cpp_baseclass); |
| break; |
| } |
| else if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS) |
| { |
| /* only look, whether there is a cpp base class |
| * declaration or initialization before the opening brace. |
| */ |
| if (cin_isterminated(l, TRUE, FALSE)) |
| break; |
| else |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * What happens next depends on the line being terminated. |
| * If terminated with a ',' only consider it terminating if |
| * there is another unterminated statement behind, eg: |
| * 123, |
| * sizeof |
| * here |
| * Otherwise check whether it is a enumeration or structure |
| * initialisation (not indented) or a variable declaration |
| * (indented). |
| */ |
| terminated = cin_isterminated(l, FALSE, TRUE); |
| |
| if (terminated == 0 || (lookfor != LOOKFOR_UNTERM |
| && terminated == ',')) |
| { |
| /* |
| * if we're in the middle of a paren thing, |
| * go back to the line that starts it so |
| * we can get the right prevailing indent |
| * if ( foo && |
| * bar ) |
| */ |
| /* |
| * position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that |
| * matching it will take us back to the start of the line. |
| */ |
| (void)find_last_paren(l, '(', ')'); |
| trypos = find_match_paren( |
| corr_ind_maxparen(ind_maxparen, &cur_curpos), |
| ind_maxcomment); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we are looking for ',', we also look for matching |
| * braces. |
| */ |
| if (trypos == NULL && terminated == ',' |
| && find_last_paren(l, '{', '}')) |
| trypos = find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment); |
| |
| if (trypos != NULL) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Check if we are on a case label now. This is |
| * handled above. |
| * case xx: if ( asdf && |
| * asdf) |
| */ |
| curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l)) |
| { |
| ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Skip over continuation lines to find the one to get the |
| * indent from |
| * char *usethis = "bla\ |
| * bla", |
| * here; |
| */ |
| if (terminated == ',') |
| { |
| while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) |
| { |
| l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); |
| if (*l == NUL || l[STRLEN(l) - 1] != '\\') |
| break; |
| --curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get indent and pointer to text for current line, |
| * ignoring any jump label. XXX |
| */ |
| if (!ind_js) |
| cur_amount = skip_label(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, |
| &l, ind_maxcomment); |
| else |
| cur_amount = get_indent(); |
| /* |
| * If this is just above the line we are indenting, and it |
| * starts with a '{', line it up with this line. |
| * while (not) |
| * -> { |
| * } |
| */ |
| if (terminated != ',' && lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM |
| && theline[0] == '{') |
| { |
| amount = cur_amount; |
| /* |
| * Only add ind_open_extra when the current line |
| * doesn't start with a '{', which must have a match |
| * in the same line (scope is the same). Probably: |
| * { 1, 2 }, |
| * -> { 3, 4 } |
| */ |
| if (*skipwhite(l) != '{') |
| amount += ind_open_extra; |
| |
| if (ind_cpp_baseclass) |
| { |
| /* have to look back, whether it is a cpp base |
| * class declaration or initialization */ |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS; |
| continue; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check if we are after an "if", "while", etc. |
| * Also allow " } else". |
| */ |
| if (cin_is_cinword(l) || cin_iselse(skipwhite(l))) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Found an unterminated line after an if (), line up |
| * with the last one. |
| * if (cond) |
| * 100 + |
| * -> here; |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM |
| || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) |
| { |
| if (cont_amount > 0) |
| amount = cont_amount; |
| else |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If this is just above the line we are indenting, we |
| * are finished. |
| * while (not) |
| * -> here; |
| * Otherwise this indent can be used when the line |
| * before this is terminated. |
| * yyy; |
| * if (stat) |
| * while (not) |
| * xxx; |
| * -> here; |
| */ |
| amount = cur_amount; |
| if (theline[0] == '{') |
| amount += ind_open_extra; |
| if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM) |
| { |
| amount += ind_level + ind_no_brace; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Special trick: when expecting the while () after a |
| * do, line up with the while() |
| * do |
| * x = 1; |
| * -> here |
| */ |
| l = skipwhite(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (cin_isdo(l)) |
| { |
| if (whilelevel == 0) |
| break; |
| --whilelevel; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * When searching for a terminated line, don't use the |
| * one between the "if" and the matching "else". |
| * Need to use the scope of this "else". XXX |
| * If whilelevel != 0 continue looking for a "do {". |
| */ |
| if (cin_iselse(l) && whilelevel == 0) |
| { |
| /* If we're looking at "} else", let's make sure we |
| * find the opening brace of the enclosing scope, |
| * not the one from "if () {". */ |
| if (*l == '}') |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = |
| (colnr_T)(l - ml_get_curline()) + 1; |
| |
| if ((trypos = find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment)) |
| == NULL |
| || find_match(LOOKFOR_IF, trypos->lnum, |
| ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment) == FAIL) |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're below an unterminated line that is not an |
| * "if" or something, we may line up with this line or |
| * add something for a continuation line, depending on |
| * the line before this one. |
| */ |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * Found two unterminated lines on a row, line up with |
| * the last one. |
| * c = 99 + |
| * 100 + |
| * -> here; |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM) |
| { |
| /* When line ends in a comma add extra indent */ |
| if (terminated == ',') |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) |
| { |
| /* Found two lines ending in ',', lineup with the |
| * lowest one, but check for cpp base class |
| * declaration/initialization, if it is an |
| * opening brace or we are looking just for |
| * enumerations/initializations. */ |
| if (terminated == ',') |
| { |
| if (ind_cpp_baseclass == 0) |
| break; |
| |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_CPP_BASECLASS; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Ignore unterminated lines in between, but |
| * reduce indent. */ |
| if (amount > cur_amount) |
| amount = cur_amount; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * Found first unterminated line on a row, may |
| * line up with this line, remember its indent |
| * 100 + |
| * -> here; |
| */ |
| amount = cur_amount; |
| |
| /* |
| * If previous line ends in ',', check whether we |
| * are in an initialization or enum |
| * struct xxx = |
| * { |
| * sizeof a, |
| * 124 }; |
| * or a normal possible continuation line. |
| * but only, of no other statement has been found |
| * yet. |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_INITIAL && terminated == ',') |
| { |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT; |
| cont_amount = cin_first_id_amount(); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_INITIAL |
| && *l != NUL |
| && l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\') |
| /* XXX */ |
| cont_amount = cin_get_equal_amount( |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum); |
| if (lookfor != LOOKFOR_TERM) |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_UNTERM; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check if we are after a while (cond); |
| * If so: Ignore until the matching "do". |
| */ |
| /* XXX */ |
| else if (cin_iswhileofdo_end(terminated, ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Found an unterminated line after a while ();, line up |
| * with the last one. |
| * while (cond); |
| * 100 + <- line up with this one |
| * -> here; |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM |
| || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) |
| { |
| if (cont_amount > 0) |
| amount = cont_amount; |
| else |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (whilelevel == 0) |
| { |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_TERM; |
| amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ |
| if (theline[0] == '{') |
| amount += ind_open_extra; |
| } |
| ++whilelevel; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * We are after a "normal" statement. |
| * If we had another statement we can stop now and use the |
| * indent of that other statement. |
| * Otherwise the indent of the current statement may be used, |
| * search backwards for the next "normal" statement. |
| */ |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * Skip single break line, if before a switch label. It |
| * may be lined up with the case label. |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_NOBREAK |
| && cin_isbreak(skipwhite(ml_get_curline()))) |
| { |
| lookfor = LOOKFOR_ANY; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Handle "do {" line. |
| */ |
| if (whilelevel > 0) |
| { |
| l = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (cin_isdo(l)) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ |
| --whilelevel; |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Found a terminated line above an unterminated line. Add |
| * the amount for a continuation line. |
| * x = 1; |
| * y = foo + |
| * -> here; |
| * or |
| * int x = 1; |
| * int foo, |
| * -> here; |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_UNTERM |
| || lookfor == LOOKFOR_ENUM_OR_INIT) |
| { |
| if (cont_amount > 0) |
| amount = cont_amount; |
| else |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Found a terminated line above a terminated line or "if" |
| * etc. line. Use the amount of the line below us. |
| * x = 1; x = 1; |
| * if (asdf) y = 2; |
| * while (asdf) ->here; |
| * here; |
| * ->foo; |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM) |
| { |
| if (!lookfor_break && whilelevel == 0) |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * First line above the one we're indenting is terminated. |
| * To know what needs to be done look further backward for |
| * a terminated line. |
| */ |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so |
| * that matching it will take us back to the start of |
| * the line. Helps for: |
| * func(asdr, |
| * asdfasdf); |
| * here; |
| */ |
| term_again: |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')') |
| && (trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Check if we are on a case label now. This is |
| * handled above. |
| * case xx: if ( asdf && |
| * asdf) |
| */ |
| curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| if (cin_iscase(l, FALSE) || cin_isscopedecl(l)) |
| { |
| ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* When aligning with the case statement, don't align |
| * with a statement after it. |
| * case 1: { <-- don't use this { position |
| * stat; |
| * } |
| * case 2: |
| * stat; |
| * } |
| */ |
| iscase = (ind_keep_case_label && cin_iscase(l, FALSE)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Get indent and pointer to text for current line, |
| * ignoring any jump label. |
| */ |
| amount = skip_label(curwin->w_cursor.lnum, |
| &l, ind_maxcomment); |
| |
| if (theline[0] == '{') |
| amount += ind_open_extra; |
| /* See remark above: "Only add ind_open_extra.." */ |
| l = skipwhite(l); |
| if (*l == '{') |
| amount -= ind_open_extra; |
| lookfor = iscase ? LOOKFOR_ANY : LOOKFOR_TERM; |
| |
| /* |
| * When a terminated line starts with "else" skip to |
| * the matching "if": |
| * else 3; |
| * indent this; |
| * Need to use the scope of this "else". XXX |
| * If whilelevel != 0 continue looking for a "do {". |
| */ |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_TERM |
| && *l != '}' |
| && cin_iselse(l) |
| && whilelevel == 0) |
| { |
| if ((trypos = find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment)) |
| == NULL |
| || find_match(LOOKFOR_IF, trypos->lnum, |
| ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment) == FAIL) |
| break; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're at the end of a block, skip to the start of |
| * that block. |
| */ |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| if (find_last_paren(l, '{', '}') |
| && (trypos = find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment)) |
| != NULL) /* XXX */ |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; |
| /* if not "else {" check for terminated again */ |
| /* but skip block for "} else {" */ |
| l = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (*l == '}' || !cin_iselse(l)) |
| goto term_again; |
| ++curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* add extra indent for a comment */ |
| if (cin_iscomment(theline)) |
| amount += ind_comment; |
| |
| /* subtract extra left-shift for jump labels */ |
| if (ind_jump_label > 0 && original_line_islabel) |
| amount -= ind_jump_label; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * ok -- we're not inside any sort of structure at all! |
| * |
| * this means we're at the top level, and everything should |
| * basically just match where the previous line is, except |
| * for the lines immediately following a function declaration, |
| * which are K&R-style parameters and need to be indented. |
| */ |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * if our line starts with an open brace, forget about any |
| * prevailing indent and make sure it looks like the start |
| * of a function |
| */ |
| |
| if (theline[0] == '{') |
| { |
| amount = ind_first_open; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the NEXT line is a function declaration, the current |
| * line needs to be indented as a function type spec. |
| * Don't do this if the current line looks like a comment or if the |
| * current line is terminated, ie. ends in ';', or if the current line |
| * contains { or }: "void f() {\n if (1)" |
| */ |
| else if (cur_curpos.lnum < curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count |
| && !cin_nocode(theline) |
| && vim_strchr(theline, '{') == NULL |
| && vim_strchr(theline, '}') == NULL |
| && !cin_ends_in(theline, (char_u *)":", NULL) |
| && !cin_ends_in(theline, (char_u *)",", NULL) |
| && cin_isfuncdecl(NULL, cur_curpos.lnum + 1, |
| cur_curpos.lnum + 1, |
| ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment) |
| && !cin_isterminated(theline, FALSE, TRUE)) |
| { |
| amount = ind_func_type; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| amount = 0; |
| curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos; |
| |
| /* search backwards until we find something we recognize */ |
| |
| while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum--; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're in a comment now, skip to the start of the comment. |
| */ /* XXX */ |
| if ((trypos = find_start_comment(ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = trypos->lnum + 1; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Are we at the start of a cpp base class declaration or |
| * constructor initialization? |
| */ /* XXX */ |
| n = FALSE; |
| if (ind_cpp_baseclass != 0 && theline[0] != '{') |
| { |
| n = cin_is_cpp_baseclass(&col); |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| } |
| if (n) |
| { |
| /* XXX */ |
| amount = get_baseclass_amount(col, ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment, ind_cpp_baseclass); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Skip preprocessor directives and blank lines. |
| */ |
| if (cin_ispreproc_cont(&l, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (cin_nocode(l)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* |
| * If the previous line ends in ',', use one level of |
| * indentation: |
| * int foo, |
| * bar; |
| * do this before checking for '}' in case of eg. |
| * enum foobar |
| * { |
| * ... |
| * } foo, |
| * bar; |
| */ |
| n = 0; |
| if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)",", NULL) |
| || (*l != NUL && (n = l[STRLEN(l) - 1]) == '\\')) |
| { |
| /* take us back to opening paren */ |
| if (find_last_paren(l, '(', ')') |
| && (trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; |
| |
| /* For a line ending in ',' that is a continuation line go |
| * back to the first line with a backslash: |
| * char *foo = "bla\ |
| * bla", |
| * here; |
| */ |
| while (n == 0 && curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) |
| { |
| l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); |
| if (*l == NUL || l[STRLEN(l) - 1] != '\\') |
| break; |
| --curwin->w_cursor.lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| } |
| |
| amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ |
| |
| if (amount == 0) |
| amount = cin_first_id_amount(); |
| if (amount == 0) |
| amount = ind_continuation; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the line looks like a function declaration, and we're |
| * not in a comment, put it the left margin. |
| */ |
| if (cin_isfuncdecl(NULL, cur_curpos.lnum, 0, |
| ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment)) /* XXX */ |
| break; |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Finding the closing '}' of a previous function. Put |
| * current line at the left margin. For when 'cino' has "fs". |
| */ |
| if (*skipwhite(l) == '}') |
| break; |
| |
| /* (matching {) |
| * If the previous line ends on '};' (maybe followed by |
| * comments) align at column 0. For example: |
| * char *string_array[] = { "foo", |
| * / * x * / "b};ar" }; / * foobar * / |
| */ |
| if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)"};", NULL)) |
| break; |
| |
| /* |
| * Find a line only has a semicolon that belongs to a previous |
| * line ending in '}', e.g. before an #endif. Don't increase |
| * indent then. |
| */ |
| if (*(look = skipwhite(l)) == ';' && cin_nocode(look + 1)) |
| { |
| pos_T curpos_save = curwin->w_cursor; |
| |
| while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 1) |
| { |
| look = ml_get(--curwin->w_cursor.lnum); |
| if (!(cin_nocode(look) || cin_ispreproc_cont( |
| &look, &curwin->w_cursor.lnum))) |
| break; |
| } |
| if (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > 0 |
| && cin_ends_in(look, (char_u *)"}", NULL)) |
| break; |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor = curpos_save; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the PREVIOUS line is a function declaration, the current |
| * line (and the ones that follow) needs to be indented as |
| * parameters. |
| */ |
| if (cin_isfuncdecl(&l, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, 0, |
| ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment)) |
| { |
| amount = ind_param; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the previous line ends in ';' and the line before the |
| * previous line ends in ',' or '\', ident to column zero: |
| * int foo, |
| * bar; |
| * indent_to_0 here; |
| */ |
| if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)";", NULL)) |
| { |
| l = ml_get(curwin->w_cursor.lnum - 1); |
| if (cin_ends_in(l, (char_u *)",", NULL) |
| || (*l != NUL && l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\')) |
| break; |
| l = ml_get_curline(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Doesn't look like anything interesting -- so just |
| * use the indent of this line. |
| * |
| * Position the cursor over the rightmost paren, so that |
| * matching it will take us back to the start of the line. |
| */ |
| find_last_paren(l, '(', ')'); |
| |
| if ((trypos = find_match_paren(ind_maxparen, |
| ind_maxcomment)) != NULL) |
| curwin->w_cursor = *trypos; |
| amount = get_indent(); /* XXX */ |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* add extra indent for a comment */ |
| if (cin_iscomment(theline)) |
| amount += ind_comment; |
| |
| /* add extra indent if the previous line ended in a backslash: |
| * "asdfasdf\ |
| * here"; |
| * char *foo = "asdf\ |
| * here"; |
| */ |
| if (cur_curpos.lnum > 1) |
| { |
| l = ml_get(cur_curpos.lnum - 1); |
| if (*l != NUL && l[STRLEN(l) - 1] == '\\') |
| { |
| cur_amount = cin_get_equal_amount(cur_curpos.lnum - 1); |
| if (cur_amount > 0) |
| amount = cur_amount; |
| else if (cur_amount == 0) |
| amount += ind_continuation; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| theend: |
| /* put the cursor back where it belongs */ |
| curwin->w_cursor = cur_curpos; |
| |
| vim_free(linecopy); |
| |
| if (amount < 0) |
| return 0; |
| return amount; |
| } |
| |
| static int |
| find_match(lookfor, ourscope, ind_maxparen, ind_maxcomment) |
| int lookfor; |
| linenr_T ourscope; |
| int ind_maxparen; |
| int ind_maxcomment; |
| { |
| char_u *look; |
| pos_T *theirscope; |
| char_u *mightbeif; |
| int elselevel; |
| int whilelevel; |
| |
| if (lookfor == LOOKFOR_IF) |
| { |
| elselevel = 1; |
| whilelevel = 0; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| elselevel = 0; |
| whilelevel = 1; |
| } |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| |
| while (curwin->w_cursor.lnum > ourscope + 1) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum--; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| |
| look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (cin_iselse(look) |
| || cin_isif(look) |
| || cin_isdo(look) /* XXX */ |
| || cin_iswhileofdo(look, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, ind_maxparen)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * if we've gone outside the braces entirely, |
| * we must be out of scope... |
| */ |
| theirscope = find_start_brace(ind_maxcomment); /* XXX */ |
| if (theirscope == NULL) |
| break; |
| |
| /* |
| * and if the brace enclosing this is further |
| * back than the one enclosing the else, we're |
| * out of luck too. |
| */ |
| if (theirscope->lnum < ourscope) |
| break; |
| |
| /* |
| * and if they're enclosed in a *deeper* brace, |
| * then we can ignore it because it's in a |
| * different scope... |
| */ |
| if (theirscope->lnum > ourscope) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* |
| * if it was an "else" (that's not an "else if") |
| * then we need to go back to another if, so |
| * increment elselevel |
| */ |
| look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (cin_iselse(look)) |
| { |
| mightbeif = cin_skipcomment(look + 4); |
| if (!cin_isif(mightbeif)) |
| ++elselevel; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * if it was a "while" then we need to go back to |
| * another "do", so increment whilelevel. XXX |
| */ |
| if (cin_iswhileofdo(look, curwin->w_cursor.lnum, ind_maxparen)) |
| { |
| ++whilelevel; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* If it's an "if" decrement elselevel */ |
| look = cin_skipcomment(ml_get_curline()); |
| if (cin_isif(look)) |
| { |
| elselevel--; |
| /* |
| * When looking for an "if" ignore "while"s that |
| * get in the way. |
| */ |
| if (elselevel == 0 && lookfor == LOOKFOR_IF) |
| whilelevel = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* If it's a "do" decrement whilelevel */ |
| if (cin_isdo(look)) |
| whilelevel--; |
| |
| /* |
| * if we've used up all the elses, then |
| * this must be the if that we want! |
| * match the indent level of that if. |
| */ |
| if (elselevel <= 0 && whilelevel <= 0) |
| { |
| return OK; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| return FAIL; |
| } |
| |
| # if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Get indent level from 'indentexpr'. |
| */ |
| int |
| get_expr_indent() |
| { |
| int indent; |
| pos_T pos; |
| int save_State; |
| int use_sandbox = was_set_insecurely((char_u *)"indentexpr", |
| OPT_LOCAL); |
| |
| pos = curwin->w_cursor; |
| set_vim_var_nr(VV_LNUM, curwin->w_cursor.lnum); |
| if (use_sandbox) |
| ++sandbox; |
| ++textlock; |
| indent = eval_to_number(curbuf->b_p_inde); |
| if (use_sandbox) |
| --sandbox; |
| --textlock; |
| |
| /* Restore the cursor position so that 'indentexpr' doesn't need to. |
| * Pretend to be in Insert mode, allow cursor past end of line for "o" |
| * command. */ |
| save_State = State; |
| State = INSERT; |
| curwin->w_cursor = pos; |
| check_cursor(); |
| State = save_State; |
| |
| /* If there is an error, just keep the current indent. */ |
| if (indent < 0) |
| indent = get_indent(); |
| |
| return indent; |
| } |
| # endif |
| |
| #endif /* FEAT_CINDENT */ |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_LISP) || defined(PROTO) |
| |
| static int lisp_match __ARGS((char_u *p)); |
| |
| static int |
| lisp_match(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| char_u buf[LSIZE]; |
| int len; |
| char_u *word = p_lispwords; |
| |
| while (*word != NUL) |
| { |
| (void)copy_option_part(&word, buf, LSIZE, ","); |
| len = (int)STRLEN(buf); |
| if (STRNCMP(buf, p, len) == 0 && p[len] == ' ') |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * When 'p' is present in 'cpoptions, a Vi compatible method is used. |
| * The incompatible newer method is quite a bit better at indenting |
| * code in lisp-like languages than the traditional one; it's still |
| * mostly heuristics however -- Dirk van Deun, dirk@rave.org |
| * |
| * TODO: |
| * Findmatch() should be adapted for lisp, also to make showmatch |
| * work correctly: now (v5.3) it seems all C/C++ oriented: |
| * - it does not recognize the #\( and #\) notations as character literals |
| * - it doesn't know about comments starting with a semicolon |
| * - it incorrectly interprets '(' as a character literal |
| * All this messes up get_lisp_indent in some rare cases. |
| * Update from Sergey Khorev: |
| * I tried to fix the first two issues. |
| */ |
| int |
| get_lisp_indent() |
| { |
| pos_T *pos, realpos, paren; |
| int amount; |
| char_u *that; |
| colnr_T col; |
| colnr_T firsttry; |
| int parencount, quotecount; |
| int vi_lisp; |
| |
| /* Set vi_lisp to use the vi-compatible method */ |
| vi_lisp = (vim_strchr(p_cpo, CPO_LISP) != NULL); |
| |
| realpos = curwin->w_cursor; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = 0; |
| |
| if ((pos = findmatch(NULL, '(')) == NULL) |
| pos = findmatch(NULL, '['); |
| else |
| { |
| paren = *pos; |
| pos = findmatch(NULL, '['); |
| if (pos == NULL || ltp(pos, &paren)) |
| pos = &paren; |
| } |
| if (pos != NULL) |
| { |
| /* Extra trick: Take the indent of the first previous non-white |
| * line that is at the same () level. */ |
| amount = -1; |
| parencount = 0; |
| |
| while (--curwin->w_cursor.lnum >= pos->lnum) |
| { |
| if (linewhite(curwin->w_cursor.lnum)) |
| continue; |
| for (that = ml_get_curline(); *that != NUL; ++that) |
| { |
| if (*that == ';') |
| { |
| while (*(that + 1) != NUL) |
| ++that; |
| continue; |
| } |
| if (*that == '\\') |
| { |
| if (*(that + 1) != NUL) |
| ++that; |
| continue; |
| } |
| if (*that == '"' && *(that + 1) != NUL) |
| { |
| while (*++that && *that != '"') |
| { |
| /* skipping escaped characters in the string */ |
| if (*that == '\\') |
| { |
| if (*++that == NUL) |
| break; |
| if (that[1] == NUL) |
| { |
| ++that; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| if (*that == '(' || *that == '[') |
| ++parencount; |
| else if (*that == ')' || *that == ']') |
| --parencount; |
| } |
| if (parencount == 0) |
| { |
| amount = get_indent(); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (amount == -1) |
| { |
| curwin->w_cursor.lnum = pos->lnum; |
| curwin->w_cursor.col = pos->col; |
| col = pos->col; |
| |
| that = ml_get_curline(); |
| |
| if (vi_lisp && get_indent() == 0) |
| amount = 2; |
| else |
| { |
| amount = 0; |
| while (*that && col) |
| { |
| amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv(&that, (colnr_T)amount); |
| col--; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Some keywords require "body" indenting rules (the |
| * non-standard-lisp ones are Scheme special forms): |
| * |
| * (let ((a 1)) instead (let ((a 1)) |
| * (...)) of (...)) |
| */ |
| |
| if (!vi_lisp && (*that == '(' || *that == '[') |
| && lisp_match(that + 1)) |
| amount += 2; |
| else |
| { |
| that++; |
| amount++; |
| firsttry = amount; |
| |
| while (vim_iswhite(*that)) |
| { |
| amount += lbr_chartabsize(that, (colnr_T)amount); |
| ++that; |
| } |
| |
| if (*that && *that != ';') /* not a comment line */ |
| { |
| /* test *that != '(' to accommodate first let/do |
| * argument if it is more than one line */ |
| if (!vi_lisp && *that != '(' && *that != '[') |
| firsttry++; |
| |
| parencount = 0; |
| quotecount = 0; |
| |
| if (vi_lisp |
| || (*that != '"' |
| && *that != '\'' |
| && *that != '#' |
| && (*that < '0' || *that > '9'))) |
| { |
| while (*that |
| && (!vim_iswhite(*that) |
| || quotecount |
| || parencount) |
| && (!((*that == '(' || *that == '[') |
| && !quotecount |
| && !parencount |
| && vi_lisp))) |
| { |
| if (*that == '"') |
| quotecount = !quotecount; |
| if ((*that == '(' || *that == '[') |
| && !quotecount) |
| ++parencount; |
| if ((*that == ')' || *that == ']') |
| && !quotecount) |
| --parencount; |
| if (*that == '\\' && *(that+1) != NUL) |
| amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv(&that, |
| (colnr_T)amount); |
| amount += lbr_chartabsize_adv(&that, |
| (colnr_T)amount); |
| } |
| } |
| while (vim_iswhite(*that)) |
| { |
| amount += lbr_chartabsize(that, (colnr_T)amount); |
| that++; |
| } |
| if (!*that || *that == ';') |
| amount = firsttry; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| amount = 0; /* no matching '(' or '[' found, use zero indent */ |
| |
| curwin->w_cursor = realpos; |
| |
| return amount; |
| } |
| #endif /* FEAT_LISP */ |
| |
| void |
| prepare_to_exit() |
| { |
| #if defined(SIGHUP) && defined(SIG_IGN) |
| /* Ignore SIGHUP, because a dropped connection causes a read error, which |
| * makes Vim exit and then handling SIGHUP causes various reentrance |
| * problems. */ |
| signal(SIGHUP, SIG_IGN); |
| #endif |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_GUI |
| if (gui.in_use) |
| { |
| gui.dying = TRUE; |
| out_trash(); /* trash any pending output */ |
| } |
| else |
| #endif |
| { |
| windgoto((int)Rows - 1, 0); |
| |
| /* |
| * Switch terminal mode back now, so messages end up on the "normal" |
| * screen (if there are two screens). |
| */ |
| settmode(TMODE_COOK); |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| if (can_end_termcap_mode(FALSE) == TRUE) |
| #endif |
| stoptermcap(); |
| out_flush(); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Preserve files and exit. |
| * When called IObuff must contain a message. |
| */ |
| void |
| preserve_exit() |
| { |
| buf_T *buf; |
| |
| prepare_to_exit(); |
| |
| /* Setting this will prevent free() calls. That avoids calling free() |
| * recursively when free() was invoked with a bad pointer. */ |
| really_exiting = TRUE; |
| |
| out_str(IObuff); |
| screen_start(); /* don't know where cursor is now */ |
| out_flush(); |
| |
| ml_close_notmod(); /* close all not-modified buffers */ |
| |
| for (buf = firstbuf; buf != NULL; buf = buf->b_next) |
| { |
| if (buf->b_ml.ml_mfp != NULL && buf->b_ml.ml_mfp->mf_fname != NULL) |
| { |
| OUT_STR(_("Vim: preserving files...\n")); |
| screen_start(); /* don't know where cursor is now */ |
| out_flush(); |
| ml_sync_all(FALSE, FALSE); /* preserve all swap files */ |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| ml_close_all(FALSE); /* close all memfiles, without deleting */ |
| |
| OUT_STR(_("Vim: Finished.\n")); |
| |
| getout(1); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * return TRUE if "fname" exists. |
| */ |
| int |
| vim_fexists(fname) |
| char_u *fname; |
| { |
| struct stat st; |
| |
| if (mch_stat((char *)fname, &st)) |
| return FALSE; |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check for CTRL-C pressed, but only once in a while. |
| * Should be used instead of ui_breakcheck() for functions that check for |
| * each line in the file. Calling ui_breakcheck() each time takes too much |
| * time, because it can be a system call. |
| */ |
| |
| #ifndef BREAKCHECK_SKIP |
| # ifdef FEAT_GUI /* assume the GUI only runs on fast computers */ |
| # define BREAKCHECK_SKIP 200 |
| # else |
| # define BREAKCHECK_SKIP 32 |
| # endif |
| #endif |
| |
| static int breakcheck_count = 0; |
| |
| void |
| line_breakcheck() |
| { |
| if (++breakcheck_count >= BREAKCHECK_SKIP) |
| { |
| breakcheck_count = 0; |
| ui_breakcheck(); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Like line_breakcheck() but check 10 times less often. |
| */ |
| void |
| fast_breakcheck() |
| { |
| if (++breakcheck_count >= BREAKCHECK_SKIP * 10) |
| { |
| breakcheck_count = 0; |
| ui_breakcheck(); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Invoke expand_wildcards() for one pattern. |
| * Expand items like "%:h" before the expansion. |
| * Returns OK or FAIL. |
| */ |
| int |
| expand_wildcards_eval(pat, num_file, file, flags) |
| char_u **pat; /* pointer to input pattern */ |
| int *num_file; /* resulting number of files */ |
| char_u ***file; /* array of resulting files */ |
| int flags; /* EW_DIR, etc. */ |
| { |
| int ret = FAIL; |
| char_u *eval_pat = NULL; |
| char_u *exp_pat = *pat; |
| char_u *ignored_msg; |
| int usedlen; |
| |
| if (*exp_pat == '%' || *exp_pat == '#' || *exp_pat == '<') |
| { |
| ++emsg_off; |
| eval_pat = eval_vars(exp_pat, exp_pat, &usedlen, |
| NULL, &ignored_msg, NULL); |
| --emsg_off; |
| if (eval_pat != NULL) |
| exp_pat = concat_str(eval_pat, exp_pat + usedlen); |
| } |
| |
| if (exp_pat != NULL) |
| ret = expand_wildcards(1, &exp_pat, num_file, file, flags); |
| |
| if (eval_pat != NULL) |
| { |
| vim_free(exp_pat); |
| vim_free(eval_pat); |
| } |
| |
| return ret; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Expand wildcards. Calls gen_expand_wildcards() and removes files matching |
| * 'wildignore'. |
| * Returns OK or FAIL. When FAIL then "num_file" won't be set. |
| */ |
| int |
| expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags) |
| int num_pat; /* number of input patterns */ |
| char_u **pat; /* array of input patterns */ |
| int *num_file; /* resulting number of files */ |
| char_u ***file; /* array of resulting files */ |
| int flags; /* EW_DIR, etc. */ |
| { |
| int retval; |
| int i, j; |
| char_u *p; |
| int non_suf_match; /* number without matching suffix */ |
| |
| retval = gen_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags); |
| |
| /* When keeping all matches, return here */ |
| if ((flags & EW_KEEPALL) || retval == FAIL) |
| return retval; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_WILDIGN |
| /* |
| * Remove names that match 'wildignore'. |
| */ |
| if (*p_wig) |
| { |
| char_u *ffname; |
| |
| /* check all files in (*file)[] */ |
| for (i = 0; i < *num_file; ++i) |
| { |
| ffname = FullName_save((*file)[i], FALSE); |
| if (ffname == NULL) /* out of memory */ |
| break; |
| # ifdef VMS |
| vms_remove_version(ffname); |
| # endif |
| if (match_file_list(p_wig, (*file)[i], ffname)) |
| { |
| /* remove this matching file from the list */ |
| vim_free((*file)[i]); |
| for (j = i; j + 1 < *num_file; ++j) |
| (*file)[j] = (*file)[j + 1]; |
| --*num_file; |
| --i; |
| } |
| vim_free(ffname); |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Move the names where 'suffixes' match to the end. |
| */ |
| if (*num_file > 1) |
| { |
| non_suf_match = 0; |
| for (i = 0; i < *num_file; ++i) |
| { |
| if (!match_suffix((*file)[i])) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Move the name without matching suffix to the front |
| * of the list. |
| */ |
| p = (*file)[i]; |
| for (j = i; j > non_suf_match; --j) |
| (*file)[j] = (*file)[j - 1]; |
| (*file)[non_suf_match++] = p; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE if "fname" matches with an entry in 'suffixes'. |
| */ |
| int |
| match_suffix(fname) |
| char_u *fname; |
| { |
| int fnamelen, setsuflen; |
| char_u *setsuf; |
| #define MAXSUFLEN 30 /* maximum length of a file suffix */ |
| char_u suf_buf[MAXSUFLEN]; |
| |
| fnamelen = (int)STRLEN(fname); |
| setsuflen = 0; |
| for (setsuf = p_su; *setsuf; ) |
| { |
| setsuflen = copy_option_part(&setsuf, suf_buf, MAXSUFLEN, ".,"); |
| if (setsuflen == 0) |
| { |
| char_u *tail = gettail(fname); |
| |
| /* empty entry: match name without a '.' */ |
| if (vim_strchr(tail, '.') == NULL) |
| { |
| setsuflen = 1; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (fnamelen >= setsuflen |
| && fnamencmp(suf_buf, fname + fnamelen - setsuflen, |
| (size_t)setsuflen) == 0) |
| break; |
| setsuflen = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| return (setsuflen != 0); |
| } |
| |
| #if !defined(NO_EXPANDPATH) || defined(PROTO) |
| |
| # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK |
| static int vim_backtick __ARGS((char_u *p)); |
| static int expand_backtick __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u *pat, int flags)); |
| # endif |
| |
| # if defined(MSDOS) || defined(FEAT_GUI_W16) || defined(WIN3264) |
| /* |
| * File name expansion code for MS-DOS, Win16 and Win32. It's here because |
| * it's shared between these systems. |
| */ |
| # if defined(DJGPP) || defined(PROTO) |
| # define _cdecl /* DJGPP doesn't have this */ |
| # else |
| # ifdef __BORLANDC__ |
| # define _cdecl _RTLENTRYF |
| # endif |
| # endif |
| |
| /* |
| * comparison function for qsort in dos_expandpath() |
| */ |
| static int _cdecl |
| pstrcmp(const void *a, const void *b) |
| { |
| return (pathcmp(*(char **)a, *(char **)b, -1)); |
| } |
| |
| # ifndef WIN3264 |
| static void |
| namelowcpy( |
| char_u *d, |
| char_u *s) |
| { |
| # ifdef DJGPP |
| if (USE_LONG_FNAME) /* don't lower case on Windows 95/NT systems */ |
| while (*s) |
| *d++ = *s++; |
| else |
| # endif |
| while (*s) |
| *d++ = TOLOWER_LOC(*s++); |
| *d = NUL; |
| } |
| # endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Recursively expand one path component into all matching files and/or |
| * directories. Adds matches to "gap". Handles "*", "?", "[a-z]", "**", etc. |
| * Return the number of matches found. |
| * "path" has backslashes before chars that are not to be expanded, starting |
| * at "path[wildoff]". |
| * Return the number of matches found. |
| * NOTE: much of this is identical to unix_expandpath(), keep in sync! |
| */ |
| static int |
| dos_expandpath( |
| garray_T *gap, |
| char_u *path, |
| int wildoff, |
| int flags, /* EW_* flags */ |
| int didstar) /* expanded "**" once already */ |
| { |
| char_u *buf; |
| char_u *path_end; |
| char_u *p, *s, *e; |
| int start_len = gap->ga_len; |
| char_u *pat; |
| regmatch_T regmatch; |
| int starts_with_dot; |
| int matches; |
| int len; |
| int starstar = FALSE; |
| static int stardepth = 0; /* depth for "**" expansion */ |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| WIN32_FIND_DATA fb; |
| HANDLE hFind = (HANDLE)0; |
| # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| WIN32_FIND_DATAW wfb; |
| WCHAR *wn = NULL; /* UCS-2 name, NULL when not used. */ |
| # endif |
| #else |
| struct ffblk fb; |
| #endif |
| char_u *matchname; |
| int ok; |
| |
| /* Expanding "**" may take a long time, check for CTRL-C. */ |
| if (stardepth > 0) |
| { |
| ui_breakcheck(); |
| if (got_int) |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* make room for file name */ |
| buf = alloc((int)STRLEN(path) + BASENAMELEN + 5); |
| if (buf == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Find the first part in the path name that contains a wildcard or a ~1. |
| * Copy it into buf, including the preceding characters. |
| */ |
| p = buf; |
| s = buf; |
| e = NULL; |
| path_end = path; |
| while (*path_end != NUL) |
| { |
| /* May ignore a wildcard that has a backslash before it; it will |
| * be removed by rem_backslash() or file_pat_to_reg_pat() below. */ |
| if (path_end >= path + wildoff && rem_backslash(path_end)) |
| *p++ = *path_end++; |
| else if (*path_end == '\\' || *path_end == ':' || *path_end == '/') |
| { |
| if (e != NULL) |
| break; |
| s = p + 1; |
| } |
| else if (path_end >= path + wildoff |
| && vim_strchr((char_u *)"*?[~", *path_end) != NULL) |
| e = p; |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| { |
| len = (*mb_ptr2len)(path_end); |
| STRNCPY(p, path_end, len); |
| p += len; |
| path_end += len; |
| } |
| else |
| #endif |
| *p++ = *path_end++; |
| } |
| e = p; |
| *e = NUL; |
| |
| /* now we have one wildcard component between s and e */ |
| /* Remove backslashes between "wildoff" and the start of the wildcard |
| * component. */ |
| for (p = buf + wildoff; p < s; ++p) |
| if (rem_backslash(p)) |
| { |
| STRMOVE(p, p + 1); |
| --e; |
| --s; |
| } |
| |
| /* Check for "**" between "s" and "e". */ |
| for (p = s; p < e; ++p) |
| if (p[0] == '*' && p[1] == '*') |
| starstar = TRUE; |
| |
| starts_with_dot = (*s == '.'); |
| pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(s, e, NULL, FALSE); |
| if (pat == NULL) |
| { |
| vim_free(buf); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* compile the regexp into a program */ |
| if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD)) |
| ++emsg_silent; |
| regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE; /* Always ignore case */ |
| regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC); |
| if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD)) |
| --emsg_silent; |
| vim_free(pat); |
| |
| if (regmatch.regprog == NULL && (flags & EW_NOTWILD) == 0) |
| { |
| vim_free(buf); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* remember the pattern or file name being looked for */ |
| matchname = vim_strsave(s); |
| |
| /* If "**" is by itself, this is the first time we encounter it and more |
| * is following then find matches without any directory. */ |
| if (!didstar && stardepth < 100 && starstar && e - s == 2 |
| && *path_end == '/') |
| { |
| STRCPY(s, path_end + 1); |
| ++stardepth; |
| (void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, (int)(s - buf), flags, TRUE); |
| --stardepth; |
| } |
| |
| /* Scan all files in the directory with "dir/ *.*" */ |
| STRCPY(s, "*.*"); |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (enc_codepage >= 0 && (int)GetACP() != enc_codepage) |
| { |
| /* The active codepage differs from 'encoding'. Attempt using the |
| * wide function. If it fails because it is not implemented fall back |
| * to the non-wide version (for Windows 98) */ |
| wn = enc_to_utf16(buf, NULL); |
| if (wn != NULL) |
| { |
| hFind = FindFirstFileW(wn, &wfb); |
| if (hFind == INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE |
| && GetLastError() == ERROR_CALL_NOT_IMPLEMENTED) |
| { |
| vim_free(wn); |
| wn = NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (wn == NULL) |
| # endif |
| hFind = FindFirstFile(buf, &fb); |
| ok = (hFind != INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE); |
| #else |
| /* If we are expanding wildcards we try both files and directories */ |
| ok = (findfirst((char *)buf, &fb, |
| (*path_end != NUL || (flags & EW_DIR)) ? FA_DIREC : 0) == 0); |
| #endif |
| |
| while (ok) |
| { |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (wn != NULL) |
| p = utf16_to_enc(wfb.cFileName, NULL); /* p is allocated here */ |
| else |
| # endif |
| p = (char_u *)fb.cFileName; |
| #else |
| p = (char_u *)fb.ff_name; |
| #endif |
| /* Ignore entries starting with a dot, unless when asked for. Accept |
| * all entries found with "matchname". */ |
| if ((p[0] != '.' || starts_with_dot) |
| && (matchname == NULL |
| || (regmatch.regprog != NULL |
| && vim_regexec(®match, p, (colnr_T)0)) |
| || ((flags & EW_NOTWILD) |
| && fnamencmp(path + (s - buf), p, e - s) == 0))) |
| { |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| STRCPY(s, p); |
| #else |
| namelowcpy(s, p); |
| #endif |
| len = (int)STRLEN(buf); |
| |
| if (starstar && stardepth < 100) |
| { |
| /* For "**" in the pattern first go deeper in the tree to |
| * find matches. */ |
| STRCPY(buf + len, "/**"); |
| STRCPY(buf + len + 3, path_end); |
| ++stardepth; |
| (void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, TRUE); |
| --stardepth; |
| } |
| |
| STRCPY(buf + len, path_end); |
| if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(path_end)) |
| { |
| /* need to expand another component of the path */ |
| /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */ |
| (void)dos_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, FALSE); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* no more wildcards, check if there is a match */ |
| /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */ |
| if (*path_end != 0) |
| backslash_halve(buf + len + 1); |
| if (mch_getperm(buf) >= 0) /* add existing file */ |
| addfile(gap, buf, flags); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (wn != NULL) |
| { |
| vim_free(p); |
| ok = FindNextFileW(hFind, &wfb); |
| } |
| else |
| # endif |
| ok = FindNextFile(hFind, &fb); |
| #else |
| ok = (findnext(&fb) == 0); |
| #endif |
| |
| /* If no more matches and no match was used, try expanding the name |
| * itself. Finds the long name of a short filename. */ |
| if (!ok && matchname != NULL && gap->ga_len == start_len) |
| { |
| STRCPY(s, matchname); |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| FindClose(hFind); |
| # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (wn != NULL) |
| { |
| vim_free(wn); |
| wn = enc_to_utf16(buf, NULL); |
| if (wn != NULL) |
| hFind = FindFirstFileW(wn, &wfb); |
| } |
| if (wn == NULL) |
| # endif |
| hFind = FindFirstFile(buf, &fb); |
| ok = (hFind != INVALID_HANDLE_VALUE); |
| #else |
| ok = (findfirst((char *)buf, &fb, |
| (*path_end != NUL || (flags & EW_DIR)) ? FA_DIREC : 0) == 0); |
| #endif |
| vim_free(matchname); |
| matchname = NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef WIN3264 |
| FindClose(hFind); |
| # ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| vim_free(wn); |
| # endif |
| #endif |
| vim_free(buf); |
| vim_free(regmatch.regprog); |
| vim_free(matchname); |
| |
| matches = gap->ga_len - start_len; |
| if (matches > 0) |
| qsort(((char_u **)gap->ga_data) + start_len, (size_t)matches, |
| sizeof(char_u *), pstrcmp); |
| return matches; |
| } |
| |
| int |
| mch_expandpath( |
| garray_T *gap, |
| char_u *path, |
| int flags) /* EW_* flags */ |
| { |
| return dos_expandpath(gap, path, 0, flags, FALSE); |
| } |
| # endif /* MSDOS || FEAT_GUI_W16 || WIN3264 */ |
| |
| #if (defined(UNIX) && !defined(VMS)) || defined(USE_UNIXFILENAME) \ |
| || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Unix style wildcard expansion code. |
| * It's here because it's used both for Unix and Mac. |
| */ |
| static int pstrcmp __ARGS((const void *, const void *)); |
| |
| static int |
| pstrcmp(a, b) |
| const void *a, *b; |
| { |
| return (pathcmp(*(char **)a, *(char **)b, -1)); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recursively expand one path component into all matching files and/or |
| * directories. Adds matches to "gap". Handles "*", "?", "[a-z]", "**", etc. |
| * "path" has backslashes before chars that are not to be expanded, starting |
| * at "path + wildoff". |
| * Return the number of matches found. |
| * NOTE: much of this is identical to dos_expandpath(), keep in sync! |
| */ |
| int |
| unix_expandpath(gap, path, wildoff, flags, didstar) |
| garray_T *gap; |
| char_u *path; |
| int wildoff; |
| int flags; /* EW_* flags */ |
| int didstar; /* expanded "**" once already */ |
| { |
| char_u *buf; |
| char_u *path_end; |
| char_u *p, *s, *e; |
| int start_len = gap->ga_len; |
| char_u *pat; |
| regmatch_T regmatch; |
| int starts_with_dot; |
| int matches; |
| int len; |
| int starstar = FALSE; |
| static int stardepth = 0; /* depth for "**" expansion */ |
| |
| DIR *dirp; |
| struct dirent *dp; |
| |
| /* Expanding "**" may take a long time, check for CTRL-C. */ |
| if (stardepth > 0) |
| { |
| ui_breakcheck(); |
| if (got_int) |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* make room for file name */ |
| buf = alloc((int)STRLEN(path) + BASENAMELEN + 5); |
| if (buf == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Find the first part in the path name that contains a wildcard. |
| * When EW_ICASE is set every letter is considered to be a wildcard. |
| * Copy it into "buf", including the preceding characters. |
| */ |
| p = buf; |
| s = buf; |
| e = NULL; |
| path_end = path; |
| while (*path_end != NUL) |
| { |
| /* May ignore a wildcard that has a backslash before it; it will |
| * be removed by rem_backslash() or file_pat_to_reg_pat() below. */ |
| if (path_end >= path + wildoff && rem_backslash(path_end)) |
| *p++ = *path_end++; |
| else if (*path_end == '/') |
| { |
| if (e != NULL) |
| break; |
| s = p + 1; |
| } |
| else if (path_end >= path + wildoff |
| && (vim_strchr((char_u *)"*?[{~$", *path_end) != NULL |
| #ifndef CASE_INSENSITIVE_FILENAME |
| || ((flags & EW_ICASE) |
| && isalpha(PTR2CHAR(path_end))) |
| #endif |
| )) |
| e = p; |
| #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE |
| if (has_mbyte) |
| { |
| len = (*mb_ptr2len)(path_end); |
| STRNCPY(p, path_end, len); |
| p += len; |
| path_end += len; |
| } |
| else |
| #endif |
| *p++ = *path_end++; |
| } |
| e = p; |
| *e = NUL; |
| |
| /* Now we have one wildcard component between "s" and "e". */ |
| /* Remove backslashes between "wildoff" and the start of the wildcard |
| * component. */ |
| for (p = buf + wildoff; p < s; ++p) |
| if (rem_backslash(p)) |
| { |
| STRMOVE(p, p + 1); |
| --e; |
| --s; |
| } |
| |
| /* Check for "**" between "s" and "e". */ |
| for (p = s; p < e; ++p) |
| if (p[0] == '*' && p[1] == '*') |
| starstar = TRUE; |
| |
| /* convert the file pattern to a regexp pattern */ |
| starts_with_dot = (*s == '.'); |
| pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(s, e, NULL, FALSE); |
| if (pat == NULL) |
| { |
| vim_free(buf); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* compile the regexp into a program */ |
| #ifdef CASE_INSENSITIVE_FILENAME |
| regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE; /* Behave like Terminal.app */ |
| #else |
| if (flags & EW_ICASE) |
| regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE; /* 'wildignorecase' set */ |
| else |
| regmatch.rm_ic = FALSE; /* Don't ignore case */ |
| #endif |
| if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD)) |
| ++emsg_silent; |
| regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC); |
| if (flags & (EW_NOERROR | EW_NOTWILD)) |
| --emsg_silent; |
| vim_free(pat); |
| |
| if (regmatch.regprog == NULL && (flags & EW_NOTWILD) == 0) |
| { |
| vim_free(buf); |
| return 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* If "**" is by itself, this is the first time we encounter it and more |
| * is following then find matches without any directory. */ |
| if (!didstar && stardepth < 100 && starstar && e - s == 2 |
| && *path_end == '/') |
| { |
| STRCPY(s, path_end + 1); |
| ++stardepth; |
| (void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, (int)(s - buf), flags, TRUE); |
| --stardepth; |
| } |
| |
| /* open the directory for scanning */ |
| *s = NUL; |
| dirp = opendir(*buf == NUL ? "." : (char *)buf); |
| |
| /* Find all matching entries */ |
| if (dirp != NULL) |
| { |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| dp = readdir(dirp); |
| if (dp == NULL) |
| break; |
| if ((dp->d_name[0] != '.' || starts_with_dot) |
| && ((regmatch.regprog != NULL && vim_regexec(®match, |
| (char_u *)dp->d_name, (colnr_T)0)) |
| || ((flags & EW_NOTWILD) |
| && fnamencmp(path + (s - buf), dp->d_name, e - s) == 0))) |
| { |
| STRCPY(s, dp->d_name); |
| len = STRLEN(buf); |
| |
| if (starstar && stardepth < 100) |
| { |
| /* For "**" in the pattern first go deeper in the tree to |
| * find matches. */ |
| STRCPY(buf + len, "/**"); |
| STRCPY(buf + len + 3, path_end); |
| ++stardepth; |
| (void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, TRUE); |
| --stardepth; |
| } |
| |
| STRCPY(buf + len, path_end); |
| if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(path_end)) /* handle more wildcards */ |
| { |
| /* need to expand another component of the path */ |
| /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */ |
| (void)unix_expandpath(gap, buf, len + 1, flags, FALSE); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* no more wildcards, check if there is a match */ |
| /* remove backslashes for the remaining components only */ |
| if (*path_end != NUL) |
| backslash_halve(buf + len + 1); |
| if (mch_getperm(buf) >= 0) /* add existing file */ |
| { |
| #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT |
| size_t precomp_len = STRLEN(buf)+1; |
| char_u *precomp_buf = |
| mac_precompose_path(buf, precomp_len, &precomp_len); |
| |
| if (precomp_buf) |
| { |
| mch_memmove(buf, precomp_buf, precomp_len); |
| vim_free(precomp_buf); |
| } |
| #endif |
| addfile(gap, buf, flags); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| closedir(dirp); |
| } |
| |
| vim_free(buf); |
| vim_free(regmatch.regprog); |
| |
| matches = gap->ga_len - start_len; |
| if (matches > 0) |
| qsort(((char_u **)gap->ga_data) + start_len, matches, |
| sizeof(char_u *), pstrcmp); |
| return matches; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) |
| static int find_previous_pathsep __ARGS((char_u *path, char_u **psep)); |
| static int is_unique __ARGS((char_u *maybe_unique, garray_T *gap, int i)); |
| static void expand_path_option __ARGS((char_u *curdir, garray_T *gap)); |
| static char_u *get_path_cutoff __ARGS((char_u *fname, garray_T *gap)); |
| static void uniquefy_paths __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u *pattern)); |
| static int expand_in_path __ARGS((garray_T *gap, char_u *pattern, int flags)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Moves "*psep" back to the previous path separator in "path". |
| * Returns FAIL is "*psep" ends up at the beginning of "path". |
| */ |
| static int |
| find_previous_pathsep(path, psep) |
| char_u *path; |
| char_u **psep; |
| { |
| /* skip the current separator */ |
| if (*psep > path && vim_ispathsep(**psep)) |
| --*psep; |
| |
| /* find the previous separator */ |
| while (*psep > path) |
| { |
| if (vim_ispathsep(**psep)) |
| return OK; |
| mb_ptr_back(path, *psep); |
| } |
| |
| return FAIL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns TRUE if "maybe_unique" is unique wrt other_paths in "gap". |
| * "maybe_unique" is the end portion of "((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[i]". |
| */ |
| static int |
| is_unique(maybe_unique, gap, i) |
| char_u *maybe_unique; |
| garray_T *gap; |
| int i; |
| { |
| int j; |
| int candidate_len; |
| int other_path_len; |
| char_u **other_paths = (char_u **)gap->ga_data; |
| char_u *rival; |
| |
| for (j = 0; j < gap->ga_len; j++) |
| { |
| if (j == i) |
| continue; /* don't compare it with itself */ |
| |
| candidate_len = (int)STRLEN(maybe_unique); |
| other_path_len = (int)STRLEN(other_paths[j]); |
| if (other_path_len < candidate_len) |
| continue; /* it's different when it's shorter */ |
| |
| rival = other_paths[j] + other_path_len - candidate_len; |
| if (fnamecmp(maybe_unique, rival) == 0 |
| && (rival == other_paths[j] || vim_ispathsep(*(rival - 1)))) |
| return FALSE; /* match */ |
| } |
| |
| return TRUE; /* no match found */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Split the 'path' option into an array of strings in garray_T. Relative |
| * paths are expanded to their equivalent fullpath. This includes the "." |
| * (relative to current buffer directory) and empty path (relative to current |
| * directory) notations. |
| * |
| * TODO: handle upward search (;) and path limiter (**N) notations by |
| * expanding each into their equivalent path(s). |
| */ |
| static void |
| expand_path_option(curdir, gap) |
| char_u *curdir; |
| garray_T *gap; |
| { |
| char_u *path_option = *curbuf->b_p_path == NUL |
| ? p_path : curbuf->b_p_path; |
| char_u *buf; |
| char_u *p; |
| int len; |
| |
| if ((buf = alloc((int)MAXPATHL)) == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| while (*path_option != NUL) |
| { |
| copy_option_part(&path_option, buf, MAXPATHL, " ,"); |
| |
| if (buf[0] == '.' && (buf[1] == NUL || vim_ispathsep(buf[1]))) |
| { |
| /* Relative to current buffer: |
| * "/path/file" + "." -> "/path/" |
| * "/path/file" + "./subdir" -> "/path/subdir" */ |
| if (curbuf->b_ffname == NULL) |
| continue; |
| p = gettail(curbuf->b_ffname); |
| len = (int)(p - curbuf->b_ffname); |
| if (len + (int)STRLEN(buf) >= MAXPATHL) |
| continue; |
| if (buf[1] == NUL) |
| buf[len] = NUL; |
| else |
| STRMOVE(buf + len, buf + 2); |
| mch_memmove(buf, curbuf->b_ffname, len); |
| simplify_filename(buf); |
| } |
| else if (buf[0] == NUL) |
| /* relative to current directory */ |
| STRCPY(buf, curdir); |
| else if (path_with_url(buf)) |
| /* URL can't be used here */ |
| continue; |
| else if (!mch_isFullName(buf)) |
| { |
| /* Expand relative path to their full path equivalent */ |
| len = (int)STRLEN(curdir); |
| if (len + (int)STRLEN(buf) + 3 > MAXPATHL) |
| continue; |
| STRMOVE(buf + len + 1, buf); |
| STRCPY(buf, curdir); |
| buf[len] = PATHSEP; |
| simplify_filename(buf); |
| } |
| |
| if (ga_grow(gap, 1) == FAIL) |
| break; |
| p = vim_strsave(buf); |
| if (p == NULL) |
| break; |
| ((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len++] = p; |
| } |
| |
| vim_free(buf); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns a pointer to the file or directory name in "fname" that matches the |
| * longest path in "ga"p, or NULL if there is no match. For example: |
| * |
| * path: /foo/bar/baz |
| * fname: /foo/bar/baz/quux.txt |
| * returns: ^this |
| */ |
| static char_u * |
| get_path_cutoff(fname, gap) |
| char_u *fname; |
| garray_T *gap; |
| { |
| int i; |
| int maxlen = 0; |
| char_u **path_part = (char_u **)gap->ga_data; |
| char_u *cutoff = NULL; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; i++) |
| { |
| int j = 0; |
| |
| while ((fname[j] == path_part[i][j] |
| # if defined(MSWIN) || defined(MSDOS) |
| || (vim_ispathsep(fname[j]) && vim_ispathsep(path_part[i][j])) |
| #endif |
| ) && fname[j] != NUL && path_part[i][j] != NUL) |
| j++; |
| if (j > maxlen) |
| { |
| maxlen = j; |
| cutoff = &fname[j]; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* skip to the file or directory name */ |
| if (cutoff != NULL) |
| while (vim_ispathsep(*cutoff)) |
| mb_ptr_adv(cutoff); |
| |
| return cutoff; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Sorts, removes duplicates and modifies all the fullpath names in "gap" so |
| * that they are unique with respect to each other while conserving the part |
| * that matches the pattern. Beware, this is at least O(n^2) wrt "gap->ga_len". |
| */ |
| static void |
| uniquefy_paths(gap, pattern) |
| garray_T *gap; |
| char_u *pattern; |
| { |
| int i; |
| int len; |
| char_u **fnames = (char_u **)gap->ga_data; |
| int sort_again = FALSE; |
| char_u *pat; |
| char_u *file_pattern; |
| char_u *curdir; |
| regmatch_T regmatch; |
| garray_T path_ga; |
| char_u **in_curdir = NULL; |
| char_u *short_name; |
| |
| remove_duplicates(gap); |
| ga_init2(&path_ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 1); |
| |
| /* |
| * We need to prepend a '*' at the beginning of file_pattern so that the |
| * regex matches anywhere in the path. FIXME: is this valid for all |
| * possible patterns? |
| */ |
| len = (int)STRLEN(pattern); |
| file_pattern = alloc(len + 2); |
| if (file_pattern == NULL) |
| return; |
| file_pattern[0] = '*'; |
| file_pattern[1] = NUL; |
| STRCAT(file_pattern, pattern); |
| pat = file_pat_to_reg_pat(file_pattern, NULL, NULL, TRUE); |
| vim_free(file_pattern); |
| if (pat == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE; /* always ignore case */ |
| regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(pat, RE_MAGIC + RE_STRING); |
| vim_free(pat); |
| if (regmatch.regprog == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| if ((curdir = alloc((int)(MAXPATHL))) == NULL) |
| goto theend; |
| mch_dirname(curdir, MAXPATHL); |
| expand_path_option(curdir, &path_ga); |
| |
| in_curdir = (char_u **)alloc_clear(gap->ga_len * sizeof(char_u *)); |
| if (in_curdir == NULL) |
| goto theend; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len && !got_int; i++) |
| { |
| char_u *path = fnames[i]; |
| int is_in_curdir; |
| char_u *dir_end = gettail_dir(path); |
| char_u *pathsep_p; |
| char_u *path_cutoff; |
| |
| len = (int)STRLEN(path); |
| is_in_curdir = fnamencmp(curdir, path, dir_end - path) == 0 |
| && curdir[dir_end - path] == NUL; |
| if (is_in_curdir) |
| in_curdir[i] = vim_strsave(path); |
| |
| /* Shorten the filename while maintaining its uniqueness */ |
| path_cutoff = get_path_cutoff(path, &path_ga); |
| |
| /* we start at the end of the path */ |
| pathsep_p = path + len - 1; |
| |
| while (find_previous_pathsep(path, &pathsep_p)) |
| if (vim_regexec(®match, pathsep_p + 1, (colnr_T)0) |
| && is_unique(pathsep_p + 1, gap, i) |
| && path_cutoff != NULL && pathsep_p + 1 >= path_cutoff) |
| { |
| sort_again = TRUE; |
| mch_memmove(path, pathsep_p + 1, STRLEN(pathsep_p)); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (mch_isFullName(path)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Last resort: shorten relative to curdir if possible. |
| * 'possible' means: |
| * 1. It is under the current directory. |
| * 2. The result is actually shorter than the original. |
| * |
| * Before curdir After |
| * /foo/bar/file.txt /foo/bar ./file.txt |
| * c:\foo\bar\file.txt c:\foo\bar .\file.txt |
| * /file.txt / /file.txt |
| * c:\file.txt c:\ .\file.txt |
| */ |
| short_name = shorten_fname(path, curdir); |
| if (short_name != NULL && short_name > path + 1 |
| #if defined(MSWIN) || defined(MSDOS) |
| /* On windows, |
| * shorten_fname("c:\a\a.txt", "c:\a\b") |
| * returns "\a\a.txt", which is not really the short |
| * name, hence: */ |
| && !vim_ispathsep(*short_name) |
| #endif |
| ) |
| { |
| STRCPY(path, "."); |
| add_pathsep(path); |
| STRMOVE(path + STRLEN(path), short_name); |
| } |
| } |
| ui_breakcheck(); |
| } |
| |
| /* Shorten filenames in /in/current/directory/{filename} */ |
| for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len && !got_int; i++) |
| { |
| char_u *rel_path; |
| char_u *path = in_curdir[i]; |
| |
| if (path == NULL) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* If the {filename} is not unique, change it to ./{filename}. |
| * Else reduce it to {filename} */ |
| short_name = shorten_fname(path, curdir); |
| if (short_name == NULL) |
| short_name = path; |
| if (is_unique(short_name, gap, i)) |
| { |
| STRCPY(fnames[i], short_name); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| rel_path = alloc((int)(STRLEN(short_name) + STRLEN(PATHSEPSTR) + 2)); |
| if (rel_path == NULL) |
| goto theend; |
| STRCPY(rel_path, "."); |
| add_pathsep(rel_path); |
| STRCAT(rel_path, short_name); |
| |
| vim_free(fnames[i]); |
| fnames[i] = rel_path; |
| sort_again = TRUE; |
| ui_breakcheck(); |
| } |
| |
| theend: |
| vim_free(curdir); |
| if (in_curdir != NULL) |
| { |
| for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; i++) |
| vim_free(in_curdir[i]); |
| vim_free(in_curdir); |
| } |
| ga_clear_strings(&path_ga); |
| vim_free(regmatch.regprog); |
| |
| if (sort_again) |
| remove_duplicates(gap); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Calls globpath() with 'path' values for the given pattern and stores the |
| * result in "gap". |
| * Returns the total number of matches. |
| */ |
| static int |
| expand_in_path(gap, pattern, flags) |
| garray_T *gap; |
| char_u *pattern; |
| int flags; /* EW_* flags */ |
| { |
| char_u *curdir; |
| garray_T path_ga; |
| char_u *files = NULL; |
| char_u *s; /* start */ |
| char_u *e; /* end */ |
| char_u *paths = NULL; |
| |
| if ((curdir = alloc((unsigned)MAXPATHL)) == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| mch_dirname(curdir, MAXPATHL); |
| |
| ga_init2(&path_ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 1); |
| expand_path_option(curdir, &path_ga); |
| vim_free(curdir); |
| if (path_ga.ga_len == 0) |
| return 0; |
| |
| paths = ga_concat_strings(&path_ga); |
| ga_clear_strings(&path_ga); |
| if (paths == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| files = globpath(paths, pattern, (flags & EW_ICASE) ? WILD_ICASE : 0); |
| vim_free(paths); |
| if (files == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* Copy each path in files into gap */ |
| s = e = files; |
| while (*s != NUL) |
| { |
| while (*e != '\n' && *e != NUL) |
| e++; |
| if (*e == NUL) |
| { |
| addfile(gap, s, flags); |
| break; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* *e is '\n' */ |
| *e = NUL; |
| addfile(gap, s, flags); |
| e++; |
| s = e; |
| } |
| } |
| vim_free(files); |
| |
| return gap->ga_len; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) || defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO) |
| /* |
| * Sort "gap" and remove duplicate entries. "gap" is expected to contain a |
| * list of file names in allocated memory. |
| */ |
| void |
| remove_duplicates(gap) |
| garray_T *gap; |
| { |
| int i; |
| int j; |
| char_u **fnames = (char_u **)gap->ga_data; |
| |
| sort_strings(fnames, gap->ga_len); |
| for (i = gap->ga_len - 1; i > 0; --i) |
| if (fnamecmp(fnames[i - 1], fnames[i]) == 0) |
| { |
| vim_free(fnames[i]); |
| for (j = i + 1; j < gap->ga_len; ++j) |
| fnames[j - 1] = fnames[j]; |
| --gap->ga_len; |
| } |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Generic wildcard expansion code. |
| * |
| * Characters in "pat" that should not be expanded must be preceded with a |
| * backslash. E.g., "/path\ with\ spaces/my\*star*" |
| * |
| * Return FAIL when no single file was found. In this case "num_file" is not |
| * set, and "file" may contain an error message. |
| * Return OK when some files found. "num_file" is set to the number of |
| * matches, "file" to the array of matches. Call FreeWild() later. |
| */ |
| int |
| gen_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags) |
| int num_pat; /* number of input patterns */ |
| char_u **pat; /* array of input patterns */ |
| int *num_file; /* resulting number of files */ |
| char_u ***file; /* array of resulting files */ |
| int flags; /* EW_* flags */ |
| { |
| int i; |
| garray_T ga; |
| char_u *p; |
| static int recursive = FALSE; |
| int add_pat; |
| #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) |
| int did_expand_in_path = FALSE; |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * expand_env() is called to expand things like "~user". If this fails, |
| * it calls ExpandOne(), which brings us back here. In this case, always |
| * call the machine specific expansion function, if possible. Otherwise, |
| * return FAIL. |
| */ |
| if (recursive) |
| #ifdef SPECIAL_WILDCHAR |
| return mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags); |
| #else |
| return FAIL; |
| #endif |
| |
| #ifdef SPECIAL_WILDCHAR |
| /* |
| * If there are any special wildcard characters which we cannot handle |
| * here, call machine specific function for all the expansion. This |
| * avoids starting the shell for each argument separately. |
| * For `=expr` do use the internal function. |
| */ |
| for (i = 0; i < num_pat; i++) |
| { |
| if (vim_strpbrk(pat[i], (char_u *)SPECIAL_WILDCHAR) != NULL |
| # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK |
| && !(vim_backtick(pat[i]) && pat[i][1] == '=') |
| # endif |
| ) |
| return mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, flags); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| recursive = TRUE; |
| |
| /* |
| * The matching file names are stored in a growarray. Init it empty. |
| */ |
| ga_init2(&ga, (int)sizeof(char_u *), 30); |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < num_pat; ++i) |
| { |
| add_pat = -1; |
| p = pat[i]; |
| |
| #ifdef VIM_BACKTICK |
| if (vim_backtick(p)) |
| add_pat = expand_backtick(&ga, p, flags); |
| else |
| #endif |
| { |
| /* |
| * First expand environment variables, "~/" and "~user/". |
| */ |
| if (vim_strchr(p, '$') != NULL || *p == '~') |
| { |
| p = expand_env_save_opt(p, TRUE); |
| if (p == NULL) |
| p = pat[i]; |
| #ifdef UNIX |
| /* |
| * On Unix, if expand_env() can't expand an environment |
| * variable, use the shell to do that. Discard previously |
| * found file names and start all over again. |
| */ |
| else if (vim_strchr(p, '$') != NULL || *p == '~') |
| { |
| vim_free(p); |
| ga_clear_strings(&ga); |
| i = mch_expand_wildcards(num_pat, pat, num_file, file, |
| flags); |
| recursive = FALSE; |
| return i; |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If there are wildcards: Expand file names and add each match to |
| * the list. If there is no match, and EW_NOTFOUND is given, add |
| * the pattern. |
| * If there are no wildcards: Add the file name if it exists or |
| * when EW_NOTFOUND is given. |
| */ |
| if (mch_has_exp_wildcard(p)) |
| { |
| #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) |
| if ((flags & EW_PATH) |
| && !mch_isFullName(p) |
| && !(p[0] == '.' |
| && (vim_ispathsep(p[1]) |
| || (p[1] == '.' && vim_ispathsep(p[2])))) |
| ) |
| { |
| /* :find completion where 'path' is used. |
| * Recursiveness is OK here. */ |
| recursive = FALSE; |
| add_pat = expand_in_path(&ga, p, flags); |
| recursive = TRUE; |
| did_expand_in_path = TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| #endif |
| add_pat = mch_expandpath(&ga, p, flags); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (add_pat == -1 || (add_pat == 0 && (flags & EW_NOTFOUND))) |
| { |
| char_u *t = backslash_halve_save(p); |
| |
| #if defined(MACOS_CLASSIC) |
| slash_to_colon(t); |
| #endif |
| /* When EW_NOTFOUND is used, always add files and dirs. Makes |
| * "vim c:/" work. */ |
| if (flags & EW_NOTFOUND) |
| addfile(&ga, t, flags | EW_DIR | EW_FILE); |
| else if (mch_getperm(t) >= 0) |
| addfile(&ga, t, flags); |
| vim_free(t); |
| } |
| |
| #if defined(FEAT_SEARCHPATH) |
| if (did_expand_in_path && ga.ga_len > 0 && (flags & EW_PATH)) |
| uniquefy_paths(&ga, p); |
| #endif |
| if (p != pat[i]) |
| vim_free(p); |
| } |
| |
| *num_file = ga.ga_len; |
| *file = (ga.ga_data != NULL) ? (char_u **)ga.ga_data : (char_u **)""; |
| |
| recursive = FALSE; |
| |
| return (ga.ga_data != NULL) ? OK : FAIL; |
| } |
| |
| # ifdef VIM_BACKTICK |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE if we can expand this backtick thing here. |
| */ |
| static int |
| vim_backtick(p) |
| char_u *p; |
| { |
| return (*p == '`' && *(p + 1) != NUL && *(p + STRLEN(p) - 1) == '`'); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Expand an item in `backticks` by executing it as a command. |
| * Currently only works when pat[] starts and ends with a `. |
| * Returns number of file names found. |
| */ |
| static int |
| expand_backtick(gap, pat, flags) |
| garray_T *gap; |
| char_u *pat; |
| int flags; /* EW_* flags */ |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| char_u *cmd; |
| char_u *buffer; |
| int cnt = 0; |
| int i; |
| |
| /* Create the command: lop off the backticks. */ |
| cmd = vim_strnsave(pat + 1, (int)STRLEN(pat) - 2); |
| if (cmd == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| #ifdef FEAT_EVAL |
| if (*cmd == '=') /* `={expr}`: Expand expression */ |
| buffer = eval_to_string(cmd + 1, &p, TRUE); |
| else |
| #endif |
| buffer = get_cmd_output(cmd, NULL, |
| (flags & EW_SILENT) ? SHELL_SILENT : 0); |
| vim_free(cmd); |
| if (buffer == NULL) |
| return 0; |
| |
| cmd = buffer; |
| while (*cmd != NUL) |
| { |
| cmd = skipwhite(cmd); /* skip over white space */ |
| p = cmd; |
| while (*p != NUL && *p != '\r' && *p != '\n') /* skip over entry */ |
| ++p; |
| /* add an entry if it is not empty */ |
| if (p > cmd) |
| { |
| i = *p; |
| *p = NUL; |
| addfile(gap, cmd, flags); |
| *p = i; |
| ++cnt; |
| } |
| cmd = p; |
| while (*cmd != NUL && (*cmd == '\r' || *cmd == '\n')) |
| ++cmd; |
| } |
| |
| vim_free(buffer); |
| return cnt; |
| } |
| # endif /* VIM_BACKTICK */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Add a file to a file list. Accepted flags: |
| * EW_DIR add directories |
| * EW_FILE add files |
| * EW_EXEC add executable files |
| * EW_NOTFOUND add even when it doesn't exist |
| * EW_ADDSLASH add slash after directory name |
| */ |
| void |
| addfile(gap, f, flags) |
| garray_T *gap; |
| char_u *f; /* filename */ |
| int flags; |
| { |
| char_u *p; |
| int isdir; |
| |
| /* if the file/dir doesn't exist, may not add it */ |
| if (!(flags & EW_NOTFOUND) && mch_getperm(f) < 0) |
| return; |
| |
| #ifdef FNAME_ILLEGAL |
| /* if the file/dir contains illegal characters, don't add it */ |
| if (vim_strpbrk(f, (char_u *)FNAME_ILLEGAL) != NULL) |
| return; |
| #endif |
| |
| isdir = mch_isdir(f); |
| if ((isdir && !(flags & EW_DIR)) || (!isdir && !(flags & EW_FILE))) |
| return; |
| |
| /* If the file isn't executable, may not add it. Do accept directories. */ |
| if (!isdir && (flags & EW_EXEC) && !mch_can_exe(f)) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Make room for another item in the file list. */ |
| if (ga_grow(gap, 1) == FAIL) |
| return; |
| |
| p = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(f) + 1 + isdir)); |
| if (p == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| STRCPY(p, f); |
| #ifdef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME |
| slash_adjust(p); |
| #endif |
| /* |
| * Append a slash or backslash after directory names if none is present. |
| */ |
| #ifndef DONT_ADD_PATHSEP_TO_DIR |
| if (isdir && (flags & EW_ADDSLASH)) |
| add_pathsep(p); |
| #endif |
| ((char_u **)gap->ga_data)[gap->ga_len++] = p; |
| } |
| #endif /* !NO_EXPANDPATH */ |
| |
| #if defined(VIM_BACKTICK) || defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO) |
| |
| #ifndef SEEK_SET |
| # define SEEK_SET 0 |
| #endif |
| #ifndef SEEK_END |
| # define SEEK_END 2 |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Get the stdout of an external command. |
| * Returns an allocated string, or NULL for error. |
| */ |
| char_u * |
| get_cmd_output(cmd, infile, flags) |
| char_u *cmd; |
| char_u *infile; /* optional input file name */ |
| int flags; /* can be SHELL_SILENT */ |
| { |
| char_u *tempname; |
| char_u *command; |
| char_u *buffer = NULL; |
| int len; |
| int i = 0; |
| FILE *fd; |
| |
| if (check_restricted() || check_secure()) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| /* get a name for the temp file */ |
| if ((tempname = vim_tempname('o')) == NULL) |
| { |
| EMSG(_(e_notmp)); |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* Add the redirection stuff */ |
| command = make_filter_cmd(cmd, infile, tempname); |
| if (command == NULL) |
| goto done; |
| |
| /* |
| * Call the shell to execute the command (errors are ignored). |
| * Don't check timestamps here. |
| */ |
| ++no_check_timestamps; |
| call_shell(command, SHELL_DOOUT | SHELL_EXPAND | flags); |
| --no_check_timestamps; |
| |
| vim_free(command); |
| |
| /* |
| * read the names from the file into memory |
| */ |
| # ifdef VMS |
| /* created temporary file is not always readable as binary */ |
| fd = mch_fopen((char *)tempname, "r"); |
| # else |
| fd = mch_fopen((char *)tempname, READBIN); |
| # endif |
| |
| if (fd == NULL) |
| { |
| EMSG2(_(e_notopen), tempname); |
| goto done; |
| } |
| |
| fseek(fd, 0L, SEEK_END); |
| len = ftell(fd); /* get size of temp file */ |
| fseek(fd, 0L, SEEK_SET); |
| |
| buffer = alloc(len + 1); |
| if (buffer != NULL) |
| i = (int)fread((char *)buffer, (size_t)1, (size_t)len, fd); |
| fclose(fd); |
| mch_remove(tempname); |
| if (buffer == NULL) |
| goto done; |
| #ifdef VMS |
| len = i; /* VMS doesn't give us what we asked for... */ |
| #endif |
| if (i != len) |
| { |
| EMSG2(_(e_notread), tempname); |
| vim_free(buffer); |
| buffer = NULL; |
| } |
| else |
| buffer[len] = NUL; /* make sure the buffer is terminated */ |
| |
| done: |
| vim_free(tempname); |
| return buffer; |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Free the list of files returned by expand_wildcards() or other expansion |
| * functions. |
| */ |
| void |
| FreeWild(count, files) |
| int count; |
| char_u **files; |
| { |
| if (count <= 0 || files == NULL) |
| return; |
| #if defined(__EMX__) && defined(__ALWAYS_HAS_TRAILING_NULL_POINTER) /* XXX */ |
| /* |
| * Is this still OK for when other functions than expand_wildcards() have |
| * been used??? |
| */ |
| _fnexplodefree((char **)files); |
| #else |
| while (count--) |
| vim_free(files[count]); |
| vim_free(files); |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return TRUE when need to go to Insert mode because of 'insertmode'. |
| * Don't do this when still processing a command or a mapping. |
| * Don't do this when inside a ":normal" command. |
| */ |
| int |
| goto_im() |
| { |
| return (p_im && stuff_empty() && typebuf_typed()); |
| } |